blob: 3c606341f1296e75d836fc24137f3a93a0985af0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Willy Tarreauc80560b2023-02-14 16:55:17 +01006 2023/02/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001239.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
193This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
194streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200198
199HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200200head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200201streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
202other streams.
203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
205connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
206leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
208processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
209waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200211HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100212 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
213 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100214 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200216 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219
2201.2. HTTP request
221-----------------
222
223First, let's consider this HTTP request :
224
225 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100226 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
228 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
229 3 User-agent: my small browser
230 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
231 5 Accept: image/png
232
233
2341.2.1. The Request line
235-----------------------
236
237Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
238
239 - a METHOD : GET
240 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
242
243All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
244which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
245followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
246is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
247desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
248the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
249
250The URI itself can have several forms :
251
252 - A "relative URI" :
253
254 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
257 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
258
259 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
260
261 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
262
263 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
264 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
265 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
266 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
267 must accept this form too.
268
269 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
270 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
271 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
274 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
275 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
276 other protocols too.
277
278In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
279mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
280on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
281It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
282specific to the language, framework or application in use.
283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100285assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.2.2. The request headers
289--------------------------
290
291The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
292beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
293an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
294Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
295values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
296encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
297the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
298define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100300Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100302"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200303as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
304normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
305representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
306HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307
308The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
309that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
310is one valid form of empty line.
311
312Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
313headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
314about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
315application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
316
317Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000318 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
320 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
321 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
322
323
3241.3. HTTP response
325------------------
326
327An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
328messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
329
330 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100331 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
333 2 Content-length: 350
334 3 Content-Type: text/html
335
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
337codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
338response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100339continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
340the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
341following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
342sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
343(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
344correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
345such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
346state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400347over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100348if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
349information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353------------------------
354
355Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
356
357 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
358 - a status code : 200
359 - a reason : OK
360
361The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
363 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
364 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
365 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
366 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000368Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100369"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
371messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
372or "Authentication Required".
373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100374HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375
376 Code When / reason
377 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
378 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
379 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100381 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 400 for an invalid or too large request
384 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
385 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100387 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100389 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
390 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400391 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200392 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100394 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200396 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
398 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
399 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
400
401The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4024.2).
403
404
4051.3.2. The response headers
406---------------------------
407
408Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
409the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
410details.
411
412
4132. Configuring HAProxy
414----------------------
415
4162.1. Configuration file format
417------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
419HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
420
421 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700423 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
427a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
430
431 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
432
433 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
434 tab characters
435
436 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
437 keyword sequences listed in this document
438
439 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
440 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
441 parts of the configuration, or expressions
442
443 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
444 are supported
445
446 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
447 section
448
449This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
450generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
451figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
452
453First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
454the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
455a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
456word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
457follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
458the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
459the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
460the parts that need to be addressed.
461
462A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
463requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
464extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
465the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
466section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
467section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
468not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
469
470A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
471each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
472a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
473start a new one.
474
475Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
476that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
477applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
478"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
479processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
480ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
481which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
482In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
483of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
484identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
485such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4862, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
487
488 listen foo
489 bind :80
490
491 listen bar
492 bind :81
493
494Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
495spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
496of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
497following configurations are strictly equivalent:
498
499 global#this is the global section
500 daemon#daemonize
501 frontend foo
502 mode http # or tcp
503
504and:
505
506 global
507 daemon
508
509 # this is the public web frontend
510 frontend foo
511 mode http
512
513The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
514new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
515other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
516section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
517section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
518at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
519
520Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
521are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
522editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
523support automatic indent.
524
525In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
526positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
527modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
528anymore, and is not recommended.
529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200530
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005312.2. Quoting and escaping
532-------------------------
533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
535that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
536possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
537in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
538('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
541very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
542the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
543also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
544delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
545word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
546remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
549(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
550
551Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
552backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200553
554 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
555 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
556 \\ to use a backslash
557 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
558 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
561C-language representation:
562
563 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
564 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
565 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
566 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
567
568Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
569or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
570of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200571
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100572 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
574 # hash as a comment start
575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
577evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
578dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
579backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200580
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100581Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
582character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
583is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
586entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
587name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
588represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
589hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100591 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
592 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
593 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
594 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
595 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
596 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
597 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
598 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
599 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
600 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
601 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200602
603 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200605 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
606 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
607 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
608 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
609 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
610
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100611There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
612necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
613by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
614they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
615escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
616characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
617case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
618if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
619own quotes.
620
621The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600622quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500623not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100624quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
625
626Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
627arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
628
629 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
631
632Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
633"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
634cannot write:
635
636 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
637
638because we would like the string to cut like this:
639
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
641 |---------|----|-|
642 arg1 _/ / /
643 arg2 __________/ /
644 arg3 ______________/
645
646but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
647parenthesis then garbage:
648
649 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650 |--------|--------|
651 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
652 trailing garbage _________/
653
654The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
655quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
656processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
657this word:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
661 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662
663So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
664still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
665the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
666the second level:
667
668 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
669 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2=blah ___________/ /
674 arg3=g _______________/
675
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500676Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100677double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
678
679 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
680 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
681 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
682 |---------||----|-|
683 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
684 arg2 ___________/ /
685 arg3 _______________/
686
687When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
688appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
689string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
690thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
691
692 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
693 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
694 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
695 |-------------| |-----||-|
696 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
697 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
698 arg3 ______________________/
699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400700Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600701that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100702quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
703single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
704level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
705
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600706Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
707if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
708or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
709
710 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
711 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
712 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
713
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
715double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100717a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
718a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
719the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
720regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
721around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
722more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200723
724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007252.3. Environment variables
726--------------------------
727
728HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
729interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
730configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
731optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
732shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200733underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
734list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
735arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100736before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
737use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
738next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
739existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 Example:
742
743 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
744
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100745 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
747 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
748
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200749Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
750file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200751
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
753 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
754
755* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
756 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
757 directory.
758
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100759* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
760 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
761 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
762
763 Example:
764 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
765 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
766
767* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
768 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
769
770* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
771 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
774
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500775* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200776 processes, separated by semicolons.
777
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500778* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779 CLI, separated by semicolons.
780
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200781In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
782regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
783only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
784
785* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
786
787* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
788 starting at one.
789
790* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
791 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
792 first section.
793
794These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
795if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
796section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
797"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
798proxies.
799
800This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
801logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
802to name some config objects like servers for example.
803
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200804See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200805
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100806
8072.4. Conditional blocks
808-----------------------
809
810It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
811some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
812ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
813configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
814versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
815preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
816text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
817lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
818switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
819are defined to form conditional blocks:
820
821 - .if <condition>
822 - .elif <condition>
823 - .else
824 - .endif
825
826The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
827as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
828matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
829there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
830only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
831".elif" of a block.
832
833Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
834ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
835as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
836
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200837Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
838See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
839
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200840The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
841expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100843 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
844 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200845 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200846 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530847 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
848 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200849 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
850 from left to right until one returns false
851 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
852 from right to left until one returns true
853
854Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
855operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200856
857The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
858
859 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
860 exists, regardless of its contents
861
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200862 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
863 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
864 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
867 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
868
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200869 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
870 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
871 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
872 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
873
874 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
875 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
876 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
877 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
878
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200879Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100880
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200881 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
882 listen mwcli_px
883 bind :1111
884 ...
885 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100886
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
888 bind :80
889 .endif
890
891 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200892 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200893 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200894 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200895 .endif
896
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200897 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200898 bind :443 ssl crt ...
899 .endif
900
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200901 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
902 profiling.memory on
903 .endif
904
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200905 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
906 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
907 .endif
908
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200909Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100910
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200911 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100912 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
913 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
914 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
915
916Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
917"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
918fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
919provide advice to the user.
920
921Example:
922
923 .if "${A}"
924 .if "${B}"
925 .notice "A=1, B=1"
926 .elif "${C}"
927 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
928 .elif "${D}"
929 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
930 .else
931 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
932 .endif
933 .else
934 .notice "A=0"
935 .endif
936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
938 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
939
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100940
9412.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200942----------------
943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100944Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
946otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
947numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
948for every keyword. Supported units are :
949
950 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
951 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
952 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
953 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
954 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
955 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
956
957
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009582.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200959-------------
960
961 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
962 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
963 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 frontend http-in
975 bind *:80
976 default_backend servers
977
978 backend servers
979 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
980
981
982 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
983 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
984 global
985 daemon
986 maxconn 256
987
988 defaults
989 mode http
990 timeout connect 5000ms
991 timeout client 50000ms
992 timeout server 50000ms
993
994 listen http-in
995 bind *:80
996 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
997
998
999Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1000
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001001 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001002
1003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010043. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005--------------------
1006
1007Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1008are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1009of them have command-line equivalents.
1010
1011The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1012
1013 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001014 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001015 - 51degrees-cache-size
1016 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001017 - 51degrees-difference
1018 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001019 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1020 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001021 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1022 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001023 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001025 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001027 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001029 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - description
1031 - deviceatlas-json-file
1032 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001034 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001035 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001036 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001037 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001039 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001041 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1042 - h1-case-adjust
1043 - h1-case-adjust-file
1044 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001045 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001046 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1047 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1048 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1049 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001050 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001051 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001052 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001053 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001055 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001056 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001057 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001058 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001059 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001060 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001061 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001062 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001063 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001065 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001066 - presetenv
1067 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001068 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001069 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001071 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001072 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001073 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - ssl-default-bind-options
1075 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001076 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001077 - ssl-default-server-options
1078 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001079 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001080 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001081 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001082 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001083 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001084 - stats
1085 - strict-limits
1086 - uid
1087 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001088 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001089 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001090 - user
1091 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001092 - wurfl-data-file
1093 - wurfl-information-list
1094 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001097 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001098 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001099 - maxcompcpuusage
1100 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001102 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001103 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001104 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001105 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001106 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001107 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001108 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001110 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001111 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001112 - nokqueue
1113 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001114 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001115 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001116 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001117 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001118 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001119 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001120 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001121 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001122 - tune.buffers.limit
1123 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001124 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001125 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001126 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001127 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001128 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001129 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001130 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001131 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001132 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001133 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001134 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001135 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001136 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001137 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001138 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001139 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001140 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1141 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001142 - tune.maxaccept
1143 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001144 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001145 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001146 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001147 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001148 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001149 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1150 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001151 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001152 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001153 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001154 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001155 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001156 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001157 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1158 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001159 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001160 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001161 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001162 - tune.sndbuf.client
1163 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001164 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001165 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001166 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1167 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1168 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001169 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1170 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001171 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001172 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1173 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001174 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001175 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001176 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001177 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1178 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1179 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001180 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1181 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001182
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001183 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001184 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001185 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001186 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001187
1188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011893.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190------------------------------------
1191
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100119251degrees-data-file <file path>
1193 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1194 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1195
1196 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001197 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001198
119951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1200 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1201 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1202 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1203
1204 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001205 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001206
120751degrees-property-separator <char>
1208 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1209 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1210
1211 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001212 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001213
121451degrees-cache-size <number>
1215 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1216 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1217 By default, this cache is disabled.
1218
1219 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001220 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001221
122251degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1223 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1224 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1225
1226 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001227 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001228
122951degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1230 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1231 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1232
1233 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001234 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001235
123651degrees-drift <number>
1237 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1238
1239 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001240 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001241
124251degrees-difference <number>
1243 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1244
1245 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001246 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001247
124851degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1249 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1250 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1251
1252 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001253 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001254
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001255ca-base <dir>
1256 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001257 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1258 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1259 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001260
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001261chroot <jail dir>
1262 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1263 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1264 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1265 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1266 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001267 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001268
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001269close-spread-time <time>
1270 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1271 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1272 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1273 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1274 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1275 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1276 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1277 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001278 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1279 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1280 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1281 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1282 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001283
1284 Arguments :
1285 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001286 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1287 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001288
1289 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1290 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1291 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1292
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001293 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001294
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001295cluster-secret <secret>
1296 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1297 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1298 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1299 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001300 tokens.
1301
1302 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1303 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1304 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001305
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001306cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1307 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1308 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1309 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1310 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1311 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001312
1313 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1314
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001315 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001316 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1317 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1318 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1319 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1320 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1321 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1322 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
1323 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside
1324 of Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1325 either 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the
1326 processes or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously,
1327 multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will
1328 replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001329
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001330 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1331 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1332 on the machine's word size.
1333
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001334 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1335 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001336 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1337 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001338 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001339 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1340 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001341
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001342 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1343 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1344 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1345 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1346 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001347
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001348 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001349 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001350 # first 4 CPUs
1351
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001352 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1353 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001354 # word size.
1355
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001356 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001357 # and so on.
1358 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1359 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1360 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1361
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001362 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1363 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1364 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1365 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001366
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001367 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1368 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1369 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001370
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001371 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1372 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1373 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1374 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1375 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1376
1377 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1378 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1379 # group may have more than 64 threads.
1380 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39 80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1381 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39 80-119
1382 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79 120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1383 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79 120-159
1384
1385
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001386crt-base <dir>
1387 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001388 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1389 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001390
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001391daemon
1392 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1393 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001394 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1395 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001396
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001397default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001398 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001399 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1400 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1401 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1402 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1403 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1404 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1405 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1406 not start with a slash ('/'):
1407 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1408 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1409
1410 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1411 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1412 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1413 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1414 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1415 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1416 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1417 each of them.
1418
1419 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1420 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1421 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1422 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1423 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1424 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1425 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1426 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1427
1428 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1429 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001430 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001431 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1432 made easily relocatable.
1433
1434 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1435 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1436 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1437 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1438 consistent across all configuration files.
1439
1440 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1441 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1442 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1443 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1444 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1445 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1446 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1447 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1448
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001449description <text>
1450 Add a text that describes the instance.
1451
1452 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1453 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1454 "<" and ">" characters.
1455
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001456deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1457 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001459
1460deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001461 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001462 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1463
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001464deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001465 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1466 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1467 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001468
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001469deviceatlas-separator <char>
1470 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1471 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1472
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001473expose-experimental-directives
1474 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1475 the config file will be rejected.
1476
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001477external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001478 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1479 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001480 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1481 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1482 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1483 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1484 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001485
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001486fd-hard-limit <number>
1487 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1488 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1489 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1490 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1491 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1492 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1493 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1494 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1495 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1496 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1497 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1498 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1499
1500 global
1501 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1502 fd-hard-limit 50000
1503
1504 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001506gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001507 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001508 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1509 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001510 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001511 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001512 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001513
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001514grace <time>
1515 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1516
1517 Arguments :
1518 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1519 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1520 soft-stop operation.
1521
1522 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1523 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1524 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1525 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1526 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1527 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1528 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1529 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1530 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1531
1532 Example:
1533
1534 global
1535 grace 10s
1536
1537 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1538 frontend ext-check
1539 bind :9999
1540 monitor-uri /ext-check
1541 monitor fail if { stopping }
1542
1543 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1544 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1545 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1546 SIGUSR1 signal.
1547
1548 Example:
1549
1550 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1551 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1552 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1553 frontend ext-check
1554 bind :9999
1555 monitor-uri /ext-check
1556 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1557
1558 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1559
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001560group <group name>
1561 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1562 See also "gid" and "user".
1563
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001564h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1565 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1566
1567 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1568 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1569 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1570 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1571 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1572 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1573 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1574
1575 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1576 option may be set.
1577
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001578h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1579 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1580 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1581 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1582 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001583 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001584 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1585 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1586 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1587 specified in a proxy.
1588
1589 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1590 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1591 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1592 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1593 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1594 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1595 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1596
1597 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1598 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1599 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1600 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1601 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1602
1603 Example:
1604 global
1605 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1606
1607 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1608 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1609
1610h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1611 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1612 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1613 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1614 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1615 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1616 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1617 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1618 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1619
1620 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1621 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1622 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1623
1624 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1625 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1626
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001627h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1628 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1629 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1630 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1631 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1632 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1633 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1634 the keyword with "no'.
1635
1636hard-stop-after <time>
1637 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1638
1639 Arguments :
1640 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1641 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1642 SIGUSR1 signal.
1643
1644 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1645 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1646 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1647
1648 Example:
1649 global
1650 hard-stop-after 30s
1651
1652 See also: grace
1653
1654httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1655 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1656 to resolve.
1657
1658 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1659 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1660
1661 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1662 configuration error if it fails to load.
1663
1664httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1665 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1666 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1667 option is "ipv6".
1668
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001669httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1670 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1671 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1672 server line.
1673
1674 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1675 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1676 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1677
1678 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1679 configuration error if it fails.
1680
1681httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1682 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1683 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1684
1685 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1686 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1687
1688 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1689 configuration error if it fails.
1690
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001691insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001692 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001693 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1694 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1695 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1696 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1697 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1698 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1699 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001700 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001701 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1702 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1703 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1704 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1705 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1706 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1707 disable it.
1708
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001709insecure-setuid-wanted
1710 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1711 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1712 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1713 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001714 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001715 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001716 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001717 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1718 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001719 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001720 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1721 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1722 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1723 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1724
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001725issuers-chain-path <dir>
1726 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1727 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1728 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001729 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001730 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1731 "issuers-chain-path".
1732 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1733 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1734 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1735 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1736 will share the chain in memory.
1737
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001738localpeer <name>
1739 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1740 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1741 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1742 the configuration parsing.
1743
1744 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1745 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1746
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001747log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001748 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001749 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001750 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001751 configured with "log global".
1752
1753 <address> can be one of:
1754
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001755 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001756 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1757 port).
1758
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001759 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1760 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1761 port).
1762
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001763 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001764 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1765 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001766 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001767
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001768 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1769 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1770 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1771 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1772 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1773 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1774 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1775 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1776 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1777 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001778 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001779 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1780 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1781 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001782 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1783 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001784
1785 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1786 "fd@2", see above.
1787
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001788 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1789 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1790 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1791 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1792 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1793
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001794 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1795 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001796
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001797 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1798 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1799 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1800 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1801 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1802 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1803 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1804 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1805 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1806 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001807 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1808 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001809
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001810 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1811 one of the following :
1812
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001813 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1814 field is stripped. This is the default.
1815 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1816 rfc3164.
1817
1818 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001819 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1820
1821 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1822 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1823
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001824 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1825 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1826 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1827 designed to be used with a local log server.
1828
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001829 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1830 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1831 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1832 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1833 logger consumes.
1834
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001835 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1836 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1837 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1838 used with a local log server.
1839
1840 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1841 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1842 designed to be used with a local log server.
1843
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001844 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1845 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1846 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1847 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1848
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001849 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1850 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1851 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1852 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1853 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1854
1855 <sample_size>
1856 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1857 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1858 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1859 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1860 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1861
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001862 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001863
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001864 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1865 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1866 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1867
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001868 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1869 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1870 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1871 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001872
1873 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001874 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1875 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1876 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1877 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1878 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1879 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001880
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001881 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001882
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001883log-send-hostname [<string>]
1884 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1885 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1886 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1887 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1888 the logs.
1889
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001890log-tag <string>
1891 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1892 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1893 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001894 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001895
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001896lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001897 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1898 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1899 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1900 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1901 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1902 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001903 used multiple times.
1904
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001905 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001906 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001907 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001908 other files.
1909
1910 local args = table.pack(...)
1911
1912lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001913 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1914 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1915 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1916 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1917 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1918 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1919 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1920 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1921 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1922 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1923 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1924 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1925 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1926 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1927 times.
1928
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001929 See lua-load for usage of args.
1930
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001931lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1932 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1933 variable.
1934 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1935 to "path".
1936
1937 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1938 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1939 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1940 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1941 will be checked earlier.
1942
1943 As an example by specifying the following path:
1944
1945 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1946 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1947
1948 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1949 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1950 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1951 paths if that does not exist either.
1952
1953 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1954 documentation.
1955
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001956master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001957 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1958 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1959 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001960 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001961 or daemon mode.
1962
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001963 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1964 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1965 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1966 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1967 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001968
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001969 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001970
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001971mworker-max-reloads <number>
1972 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001973 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001974 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1975 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1976 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1977
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001978nbthread <number>
1979 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001980 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1981 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1982 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1983 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1984 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1985 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1986 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001987
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01001988no-quic
1989 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
1990 change without deprecation in the future.
1991
1992 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
1993 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
1994 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
1995
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001996numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001997 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1998 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1999 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2000 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2001 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2002 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2003 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2004 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2005 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2006 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002007
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002008pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002009 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2010 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2011 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2012 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002013
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002014pp2-never-send-local
2015 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2016 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2017 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2018 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2019 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2020 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2021 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2022 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2023 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2024 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2025 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2026
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002027presetenv <name> <value>
2028 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2029 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2030 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2031 and "unsetenv".
2032
2033resetenv [<name> ...]
2034 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2035 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2036 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2037 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2038 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2039 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2040 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2041 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2042
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002043server-state-base <directory>
2044 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002045 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2046 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002047
2048server-state-file <file>
2049 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2050 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2051 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2052 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2053 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2054 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2055 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2056 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002057 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2058 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002059
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002060set-dumpable
2061 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2062 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2063 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2064 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2065 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2066 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2067 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2068 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2069 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2070 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2071 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2072 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2073 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2074 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2075 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2076 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2077 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2078 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2079
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002080set-var <var-name> <expr>
2081 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2082 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2083 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2084 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2085 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2086 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002087 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002088 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2089 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2090
2091 Example:
2092 global
2093 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2094 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2095 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2096
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002097set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2098 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2099 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2100 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2101 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2102 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2103 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2104 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2105 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2106 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2107 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2108
2109 Example:
2110 global
2111 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2112 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2113
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002114setenv <name> <value>
2115 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2116 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2117 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2118 and "unsetenv".
2119
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002120ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2122 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002123 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002124 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002125 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2126 information and recommendations see e.g.
2127 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2128 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2129 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2130 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002131
2132ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2134 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2135 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2136 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2137 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002138 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2139 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2140 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002141 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002142
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002143ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2144 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2145 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2146 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2147 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2148 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2149
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002150ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2151 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2152 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2153 keyword to see available options.
2154
2155 Example:
2156 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002157 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002158
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002159ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2161 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002162 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002163 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002164 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2165 information and recommendations see e.g.
2166 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2167 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2168 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2169 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2170 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002171
2172ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2174 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2175 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2176 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2177 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002178 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2179 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2180 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2181 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002182
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002183ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2185 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2186 keyword to see available options.
2187
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002188ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2190 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2191 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002192 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002193 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002194 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002195 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2196 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2197 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2198 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002199 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2200 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2201 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2202
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002203ssl-propquery <query>
2204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2205 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2206 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2207 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2208 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2209 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2210 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2211 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2212 was not found.
2213
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002214ssl-provider <name>
2215 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2216 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2217 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2218 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2219 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2220 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002221
2222 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002223 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2224 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2225 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2226 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2227 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002228
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002229 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2230 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2231 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2232 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002233
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002234 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2235
2236ssl-provider-path <path>
2237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2238 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2239 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2240 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2241 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2242 defined.
2243 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002244
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002245ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2246 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2247 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002248 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002249 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002250 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2251
2252 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002253
2254 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2255 and won't try to remove them.
2256
2257 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2258
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002259ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002260 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002261 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2262 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2263 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002264
2265 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2266 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2267 optimize the startup time.
2268
2269 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2270 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2271 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2272
2273 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002274 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002275
2276 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002277 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2278 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002279
2280 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2281 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2282 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2283 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2284 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002285 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002286
2287 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002288 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002289 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2290 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2291 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2292 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2293 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002294 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002295
2296 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2297
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002298 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002299 a cert bundle.
2300
2301 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2302 separately in several "crt".
2303
2304 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2305 since files are loading separately.
2306
2307 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2308 required to commit them.
2309
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002310 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002311 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002312
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002313 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2314 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2315 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002316
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002317 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2318 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2319 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002320
2321 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002322 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2323 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002324
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002325 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2326 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2327
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002328 The default behavior is "all".
2329
2330 Example:
2331 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2332 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2333 ssl-load-extra-files none
2334
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002335 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2336 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002337
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002338ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2339 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2340 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2341 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2342
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002343ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002344 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002345 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2346 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2347 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2348 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2349 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2350 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002351 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002352
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002353stats maxconn <connections>
2354 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2355 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2356
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002357stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2358 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2359 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2360 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002361 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002362 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002363
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002364 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2365 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2366 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002367
2368stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2369 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2370 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002371 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002372
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002373strict-limits
2374 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2375 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2376 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2377 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2378 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002379
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002380thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2381 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2382 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2383 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2384 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2385 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2386 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2387 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2388 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2389 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2390
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002391thread-groups <number>
2392 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2393 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002394 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2395 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2396 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2397 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2398 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002399
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002400trace <args...>
2401 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2402 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2403 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2404 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2405 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2406 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2407 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2408 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2409 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2410 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2411 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2412 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2413 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2414 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2415 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2416 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2417 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2418
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002419uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002420 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002421 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2422 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2423 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2424
2425ulimit-n <number>
2426 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2427 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002428 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2429 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002430
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002431 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2432 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2433 manually specify this value.
2434
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002435 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2436
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002437unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2438 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2439
2440 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2441 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2442 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2443 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2444 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002445 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002446 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2447 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2448 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2449 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2450
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002451unsetenv [<name> ...]
2452 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2453 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2454 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2455 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2456 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2457 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2458 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2459
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002460user <user name>
2461 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2462 See also "uid" and "group".
2463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002464node <name>
2465 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2466
2467 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2468 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2469 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2470 traffic.
2471
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002472wurfl-cache-size <size>
2473 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2474 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2475 - "0" : no cache is used.
2476 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002477
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002478 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2479 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002480
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002481wurfl-data-file <file path>
2482 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2483 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2484
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002485 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002486 with USE_WURFL=1.
2487
2488wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2489 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2490 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2491 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2492
2493 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2494
2495 Valid WURFL properties are:
2496 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2497
2498 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2499 device.
2500
2501 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2502 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2503
2504 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2505 particular web request.
2506
2507 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2508 used Libwurfl API version.
2509
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002510 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2511 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2512
2513 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2514 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2515
2516 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2517
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002518 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002519 with USE_WURFL=1.
2520
2521wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2522 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2523 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2524
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002525 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002526 with USE_WURFL=1.
2527
2528wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2529 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2530 thus before the chroot.
2531
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002532 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002533 with USE_WURFL=1.
2534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025353.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536-----------------------
2537
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002538busy-polling
2539 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2540 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2541 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2542 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2543 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2544 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2545 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2546 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2547 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2548 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2549 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2550 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2551 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2552 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2553 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2554 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2555 "poll" pollers.
2556
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002557 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2558 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2559 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2560
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002561max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002562 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002563 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2564 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2565 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2566 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2567 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2568 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2569 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2570
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002571maxcompcpuusage <number>
2572 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2573 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2574 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2575 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2576 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2577 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2578 and from introducing high latencies.
2579
2580maxcomprate <number>
2581 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2582 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2583 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2584 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2585 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2586 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2587 default value.
2588
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589maxconn <number>
2590 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2591 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2592 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002593 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2594 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2595 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2596 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002597 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2598 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2599 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2600 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2601 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002602 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2603
2604 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002605
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002606maxconnrate <number>
2607 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2608 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2609 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2610 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2611 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2612 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2613 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2614 fairness.
2615
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002616maxpipes <number>
2617 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2618 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2619 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2620 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2621 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2622 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2623
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002624maxsessrate <number>
2625 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2626 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2627 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2628 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2629 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2630 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2631 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2632 fairness.
2633
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002634maxsslconn <number>
2635 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2636 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2637 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2638 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2639 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2640 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2641 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002642 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2643 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2644 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2645 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002646 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002647 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2648 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002649
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002650maxsslrate <number>
2651 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2652 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2653 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2654 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2655 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2656 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2657 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2658 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2659 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2660 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2661
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002662maxzlibmem <number>
2663 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2664 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2665 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002666 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2667 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2668 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2669
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002670no-memory-trimming
2671 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2672 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2673 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2674 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2675 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2676 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2677 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2678 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2679 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2680 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2681 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2682 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2683 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2684 not suffer from such a problem.
2685
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002686noepoll
2687 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2688 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002689 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002690
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002691noevports
2692 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2693 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2694 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2695 also "nopoll".
2696
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002697nogetaddrinfo
2698 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2699 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2700
2701nokqueue
2702 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2703 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2704 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002706nopoll
2707 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2708 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002710 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2711 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002712
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002713noreuseport
2714 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2715 command line argument "-dR".
2716
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002717nosplice
2718 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002719 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002720 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002721 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002722 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2723 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2724 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2725 "option splice-response".
2726
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002727profiling.memory { on | off }
2728 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2729 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2730 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2731 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2732 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2733 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2734 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2735 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2736 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2737
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002738profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2739 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2740 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2741 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2742 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002743 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002744 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2745 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2746 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2747 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2748
2749 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2750 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2751 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2752 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2753 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002754 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2755 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2756 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2757 CLI.
2758
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002759spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002760 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2761 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2762 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2763 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2764 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2765 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002766
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002767ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002768 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002769 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002770 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002771 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002772 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2773 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2774 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002775 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2776 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002777 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2778 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2779 openssl configuration file uses:
2780 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2781
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002782ssl-mode-async
2783 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002784 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002785 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2786 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002787 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002788 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002789 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002790
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002791tune.buffers.limit <number>
2792 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2793 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2794 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2795 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2796 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002797 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002798 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2799 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2800 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2801 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2802 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2803 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2804 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2805 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002806 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002807
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002808tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2809 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2810 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2811 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002812 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002813
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002814tune.bufsize <number>
2815 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2816 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2817 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2818 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2819 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2820 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2821 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002822 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2823 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002824 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002825 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002826 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002827 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2828 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002829
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002830tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2831 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2832 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2833 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2834 this value. The default value is 1.
2835
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002836tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2837 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2838 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2839 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2840 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2841 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2842 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2843 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2844 appear on a line before this directive.
2845
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002846tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002847 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2848 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2849 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2850 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002851
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002852tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2853 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2854 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2855 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2856 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2857 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2858
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002859tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2860 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2861 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2862 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2863 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2864 change it.
2865
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002866tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2867 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002868 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002869 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Glenn Strauss0012f892022-06-04 22:11:50 -04002870 The default value is 65536, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002871 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2872 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2873 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2874 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2875
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002876tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2877 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2878 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2879 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2880 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2881 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002882 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002883 recommended not to change this value.
2884
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002885tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002886 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002887 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002888 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002889 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2890 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2891 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2892 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2893
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002894tune.http.cookielen <number>
2895 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2896 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2897 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2898 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2899 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2900 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2901 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2902 to change this value.
2903
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002904tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002905 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2906 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002907 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002908 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002909 configuration directives too.
2910 The default value is 1024.
2911
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002912tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2913 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2914 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2915 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2916 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2917 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2918 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002919 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2920 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2921 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002922
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002923tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2924 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2925 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2926 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2927 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2928 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2929 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002930 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2931 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2932 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2933 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2934 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002935
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002936tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002937 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002938 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2939 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2940 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2941 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002942 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002943 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002944 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002945 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2946
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002947tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2948 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2949 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2950 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2951 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2952 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2953 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2954 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2955 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2956 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2957
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002958tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2959 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002960 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002961 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2962 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002963 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002964 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2965 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2966
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002967tune.lua.maxmem
2968 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2969 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2970 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2971 memory.
2972
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002973tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2974 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002975 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2976 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002977 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002978
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002979tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2980 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2981 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2982 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002983 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002984
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002985tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2986 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2987 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2988 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2989 check servers.
2990
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002991tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002992 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2993 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002994 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2995 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2996 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2997 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2998 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2999 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3000 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3001 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3002 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003003
3004tune.maxpollevents <number>
3005 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3006 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3007 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3008 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3009 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3010
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003011tune.maxrewrite <number>
3012 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3013 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3014 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3015 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3016 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3017 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3018 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3019 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3020 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3021 bufsize.
3022
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003023tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3024 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3025 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3026 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3027 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3028 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3029 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3030 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3031 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3032 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3033 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3034 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3035 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3036 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3037 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3038
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003039tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3040 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3041 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3042 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3043 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3044 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3045 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3046 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3047 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3048 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003049 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3050 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003051 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3052 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3053 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3054 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3055 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3056 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3057 setting this parameter to 0.
3058
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003059tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3060 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3061 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3062 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3063 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3064 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3065 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3066 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3067
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003068tune.pipesize <number>
3069 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3070 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3071 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3072 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3073 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3074 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3075
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003076tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3077 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003078 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003079 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3080 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3081 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3082 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003083 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003084
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003085tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3086 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003087 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003088 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3089 default is 20.
3090
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003091tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003092 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3093 change without deprecation in the future.
3094
3095 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3096 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3097 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3098 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003099 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003100
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003101tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
3102 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3103 change without deprecation in the future.
3104
3105 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3106 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3107 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3108 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3109 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3110 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3111 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3112
3113 The default value is 30000.
3114
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003115tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
3116 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3117 change without deprecation in the future.
3118
3119 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3120 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3121 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3122 requests.
3123
3124 The default value is 100.
3125
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003126tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
3127 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3128 change without deprecation in the future.
3129
3130 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3131 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3132
3133 The default value is 10.
3134
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003135tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
3136 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3137 change without deprecation in the future.
3138
3139 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003140 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3141 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003142 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3143 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003144 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3145 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003146
3147 The default value is 100.
3148
3149 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3150 information about QUIC retry.
3151
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003152tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
3153 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3154 change without deprecation in the future.
3155
3156 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3157 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3158 own socket.
3159
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003160 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3161 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003162 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
3163 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC
3164 connections. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
3165 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
3166 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003167
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003168 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3169 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3170 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003171 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003172 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003173
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003174tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3175tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3176 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3177 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3178 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003179 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003180 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003181 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3182 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3183
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003184tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003185 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003186 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3187 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3188 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3189 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3190
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003191tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003192 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003193 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3194 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3195 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3196 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3197 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3198 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3199 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003200
3201tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3202 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003203 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003204 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3205 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3206 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3207 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3208 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3209 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3210 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003211
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003212tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3213tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3214 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3215 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3216 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003217 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003218 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003219 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3220 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3221 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3222 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003223 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003224
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003225tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003226 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003227 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3228 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3229 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3230 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3231 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3232 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3233 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3234 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3235 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003236 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3237 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003238
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003239tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3240tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3241 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3242 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3243 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3244 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3245
3246tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3247 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3248 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3249 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3250 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3251 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3252 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3253 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3254 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3255 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3256 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3257 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3258 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3259
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003260tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003261 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003262 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3263 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3264 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3265 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3266 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3267
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003268tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3269 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3270 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3271 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3272 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3273
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003274tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3275 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3276 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3277 performances. This is disabled by default.
3278
3279 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3280 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3281
3282 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3283
3284 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3285
3286 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3287
3288 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3289 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3290 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3291
3292 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3293 converted.
3294
3295 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3296 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3297 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3298 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3299 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3300 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3301 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003302 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3303 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003304
3305 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3306
3307 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3308 only need this line:
3309
3310 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3311
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003312tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3313 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003314 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003315 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3316 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3317 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3318 being used for too long.
3319
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003320tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003321 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3322 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3323 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3324 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3325 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3326 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3327 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3328 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3329 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3330 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3331 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3332 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3333 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003334
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003335tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3336 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3337 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3338 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3339 1000 entries.
3340
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003341tune.stick-counters <number>
3342 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3343 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
3344 "http-request" rules. The defaut value is set at build time by the macro
3345 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3346 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3347 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3348 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3349 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3350 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3351 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3352 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3353 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3354 entirely disable stick-counters).
3355
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003356tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003357tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003358tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3359tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3360tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003361 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3362 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3363 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3364 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3365 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3366 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3367 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3368 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003369
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003370 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3371 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3372 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3373 all available space is consumed.
3374 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3375 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3376 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003377
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003378tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3379 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003380 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003381 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003382 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003383 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3384
3385tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3386 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3387 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003388 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3389 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033913.3. Debugging
3392--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003393
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003394anonkey <key>
3395 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3396 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3397 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Erwan Le Goasb0c05012022-09-14 17:51:55 +02003398 from the CLI command "set global-key". See also command line argument "-dC"
3399 in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003400
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003401quick-exit
3402 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3403 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3404 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3405 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3406 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3407 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3408 do so by developers.
3409
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003410quiet
3411 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3412 line argument "-q".
3413
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003414zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003415 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003416 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3417 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3418 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3419 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3420 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3421
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010034233.4. Userlists
3424--------------
3425It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3426http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3427it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3428
3429userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003430 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003431 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3432
3433group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003434 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003435 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3436 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3437
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003438user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3439 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003440 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3441 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003442 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3443 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3444 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3445 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003446
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003447 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3448 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3449 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3450 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3451 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3452 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3453 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003454 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003455 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003456
3457 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003458 userlist L1
3459 group G1 users tiger,scott
3460 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003461
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003462 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3463 user scott insecure-password elgato
3464 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003465
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003466 userlist L2
3467 group G1
3468 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003469
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003470 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3471 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3472 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003473
3474 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003475
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003476
34773.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003478----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003479It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003480several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003481instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003482values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3483type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3484values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3485active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3486switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3487present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3488watch it.
3489
3490Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3491known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3492the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3493process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3494during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3495tables.
3496
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003497Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3498that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3499each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003500
3501peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003502 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003503 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3504
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003505bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3506 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3507 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3508
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003509disabled
3510 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3511 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3512 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3513
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003514default-bind [param*]
3515 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3516
3517default-server [param*]
3518 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3519
3520 Arguments:
3521 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3522 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003523 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3524 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3525 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3526 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003527
3528 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3529
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003530enabled
3531 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3532 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003533
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003534log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003535 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3536 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3537 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3538 more details.
3539
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003540peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003541 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3542 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003543 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003544 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003545 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3546 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3547 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003548
3549 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3550 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3551
3552 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003553 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3554 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3555 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003556
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003557 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3558 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003559
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003560 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3561 "server" keyword explanation below).
3562
3563server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003564 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003565 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3566 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3567 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3568 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003569
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003570 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3571 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3572 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3573 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3574 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003576 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003577 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003578 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003579 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3580 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3581 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003582
3583 backend mybackend
3584 mode tcp
3585 balance roundrobin
3586 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3587 stick on src
3588
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003589 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3590 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003591
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003592 Example:
3593 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003594 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3595 default-server ssl verify none
3596 server haproxy1 #local peer
3597 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3598 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003599
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003600shards <shards>
3601
3602 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3603 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3604 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3605 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3606 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003607
3608table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3609 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3610
3611 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3612 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003613 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003614 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3615 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3616 "stick-table" keyword).
3617
3618 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3619 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3620 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3621 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3622 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3623 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3624 of the stick-table name as follows:
3625
3626 peers mypeers
3627 peer A ...
3628 peer B ...
3629 table t1 ...
3630
3631 frontend fe1
3632 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3633
3634 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3635 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3636
3637 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3638 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3639 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3640 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3641 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3642 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3643 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3644
3645 peers mypeers
3646 peer A ...
3647 peer B ...
3648 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3649
3650 backend t1
3651 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3652
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003653 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003654 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3655 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3656
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090036573.6. Mailers
3658------------
3659It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3660If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3661in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3662
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003663mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003664 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3665 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3666
3667mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3668 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3669
3670 Example:
3671 mailers mymailers
3672 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3673 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3674
3675 backend mybackend
3676 mode tcp
3677 balance roundrobin
3678
3679 email-alert mailers mymailers
3680 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3681 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3682
3683 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3684 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3685
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003686timeout mail <time>
3687 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3688 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3689 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3690 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3691
3692 Example:
3693 mailers mymailers
3694 timeout mail 20s
3695 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003696
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020036973.7. Programs
3698-------------
3699In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3700master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3701managed the same way as the workers.
3702
3703During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3704sequence as a worker:
3705
3706 - the master is re-executed
3707 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3708 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3709 instance of the program
3710
3711During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3712
3713program <name>
3714 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3715 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3716 the management guide).
3717
3718command <command> [arguments*]
3719 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3720 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3721 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3722 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3723
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003724user <user name>
3725 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3726 See also "group".
3727
3728group <group name>
3729 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3730 See also "user".
3731
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003732option start-on-reload
3733no option start-on-reload
3734 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3735 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3736 program section.
3737
3738
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010037393.8. HTTP-errors
3740----------------
3741
3742It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3743imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3744several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3745
3746http-errors <name>
3747 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3748 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3749
3750errorfile <code> <file>
3751 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3752
3753 Arguments :
3754 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003755 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003756 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003757
3758 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3759 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3760 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3761 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3762 before any chroot is performed.
3763
3764 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3765
3766 Example:
3767 http-errors website-1
3768 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3769 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3770 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3771
3772 http-errors website-2
3773 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3774 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3775 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3776
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020037773.9. Rings
3778----------
3779
3780It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3781servers or traces.
3782
3783ring <ringname>
3784 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3785
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003786backing-file <path>
3787 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
3788 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
3789 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
3790 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
3791 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
3792 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
3793 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
3794
3795 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
3796 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
3797 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
3798 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02003799 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
3800 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
3801 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
3802 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
3803 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
3804 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
3805 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
3806 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
3807 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
3808 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
3809 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
3810 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003811
3812 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
3813 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
3814 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
3815 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
3816 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
3817 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
3818 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
3819
3820 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
3821 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
3822 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
3823
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003824description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003825 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003826 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3827
3828format <format>
3829 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3830
3831 Arguments:
3832 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3833 one of the following :
3834
3835 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3836 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3837 designed to be used with a local log server.
3838
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003839 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3840 field is stripped. This is the default.
3841 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3842 rfc3164.
3843
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003844 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3845 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3846 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3847 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3848 is the default.
3849
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003850 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003851 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3852
3853 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3854 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3855
3856 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3857 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3858 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3859 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3860 logger consumes.
3861
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003862 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3863 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3864 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3865 with a local log server.
3866
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003867 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3868 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3869 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3870 used with a local log server.
3871
3872maxlen <length>
3873 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3874 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3875 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3876
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003877server <name> <address> [param*]
3878 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3879 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3880 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3881 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3882 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3883 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3884 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3885 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3886 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003887 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3888 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003889
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003890size <size>
3891 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3892 set to BUFSIZE.
3893
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003894timeout connect <timeout>
3895 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3896
3897 Arguments :
3898 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3900 as explained at the top of this document.
3901
3902timeout server <timeout>
3903 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3904
3905 Arguments :
3906 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3907 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3908 as explained at the top of this document.
3909
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003910 Example:
3911 global
3912 log ring@myring local7
3913
3914 ring myring
3915 description "My local buffer"
3916 format rfc3164
3917 maxlen 1200
3918 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003919 timeout connect 5s
3920 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003921 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003922
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020039233.10. Log forwarding
3924-------------------
3925
3926It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003927HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003928
3929log-forward <name>
3930 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3931
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003932backlog <conns>
3933 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3934 on connections accept.
3935
3936bind <addr> [param*]
3937 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003938 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3939 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3940 syslog protocol over TCP.
3941 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003942 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3943
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003944dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003945 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3946 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3947 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3948 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003949 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003950
3951log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003952log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003953 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3954 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3955 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003956 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003957 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3958 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3959 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003960 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003961
3962 Example:
3963 global
3964 log stderr format iso local7
3965
3966 ring myring
3967 description "My local buffer"
3968 format rfc5424
3969 maxlen 1200
3970 size 32764
3971 timeout connect 5s
3972 timeout server 10s
3973 # syslog tcp server
3974 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3975
3976 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003977 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3978 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003979 # all messages on stderr
3980 log global
3981 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3982 log ring@myring local0
3983 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3984 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3985 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3986 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3987 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003988
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003989maxconn <conns>
3990 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3991 10 is the default.
3992
3993timeout client <timeout>
3994 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020039964. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003997----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003998
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003999Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004000 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4001 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4002 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4003 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004004
4005A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4006connections.
4007
4008A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4009to forward incoming connections.
4010
4011A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4012parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4013
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004014A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4015ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4016sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4017the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4018explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4019from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4020"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4021for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4022to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4023optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4024are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4025any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4026names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4027that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4028duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004029names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4030is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4031implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4032encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4033adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004034
4035Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4036settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4037of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4038profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4039timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004041All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4042'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4043case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4044
4045Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4046logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4047proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4048However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4049name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4050
4051Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4052and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004053bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004054protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4055modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4056arbitrary criteria.
4057
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004058In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4059a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004060the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004061
4062 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4063 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4064 between responses and new requests.
4065
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004066 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4067 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4068 client-facing connection remains open.
4069
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004070 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4071 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004072
4073The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4074frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4075following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004076weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004077
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004078 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004079
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004080 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4081 ----+-----+-----+----
4082 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4083 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004084 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4085 ----+-----+-----+----
4086 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004087
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004088It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004089only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4090within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004091as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004092content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004093and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4094possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004095
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004096There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004097first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004098processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004099second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004100protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4101is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4102new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004103to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004104process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4105already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4106HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4107evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4108one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4109
4110There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4111performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4112tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4113preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4114analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4115HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4116header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4117mitigate this drawback.
4118
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004119There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004120method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4121set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4122in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4123is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4124to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4125above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4126to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4127"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4128frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4129frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4130as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4131upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4132on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4133the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4134upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4135frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4136remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020041384.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4139--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004141The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4142limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4143they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4144limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004145marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004146option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004147and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4148with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004149specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4150sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4151anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004153
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004154 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4155------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004156acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004157backlog X X X -
4158balance X - X X
4159bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004160capture cookie - X X -
4161capture request header - X X -
4162capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004163clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4164clitcpka-idle X X X -
4165clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004166compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004167cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004168declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004169default-server X - X X
4170default_backend X X X -
4171description - X X X
4172disabled X X X X
4173dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004174email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004175email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004176email-alert mailers X X X X
4177email-alert myhostname X X X X
4178email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004179enabled X X X X
4180errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004181errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004182errorloc X X X X
4183errorloc302 X X X X
4184-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4185errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004186error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004187force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004188filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004189fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004190hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004191http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004192http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004193http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004194http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004195http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004196http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004197http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004198http-check set-var X - X X
4199http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004200http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004201http-request X (!) X X X
4202http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004203http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004204http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004205id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004206ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004207load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004208log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004209log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004210log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004211log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004212max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004213maxconn X X X -
4214mode X X X X
4215monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004216monitor-uri X X X -
4217option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4218option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4219option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4220option allbackups (*) X - X X
4221option checkcache (*) X - X X
4222option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4223option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004224option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004225option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4226option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004227-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4228option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004229option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004230option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4231option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004232option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004233option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004234option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004235option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004236option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004237option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004238option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4239option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4240option httpchk X - X X
4241option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004242option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004243option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004244option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004245option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004246option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004247option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4248option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4249option logasap (*) X X X -
4250option mysql-check X - X X
4251option nolinger (*) X X X X
4252option originalto X X X X
4253option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004254option pgsql-check X - X X
4255option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004256option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004257option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004258option smtpchk X - X X
4259option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4260option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4261option splice-request (*) X X X X
4262option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004263option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004264option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4265option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4266-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004267option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004268option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4269option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4270option tcpka X X X X
4271option tcplog X X X X
4272option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004273option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004274external-check command X - X X
4275external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004276persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4277rate-limit sessions X X X -
4278redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004279-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004280retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004281retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004282server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004283server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004284server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004285source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004286srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4287srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4288srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004289stats admin - X X X
4290stats auth X X X X
4291stats enable X X X X
4292stats hide-version X X X X
4293stats http-request - X X X
4294stats realm X X X X
4295stats refresh X X X X
4296stats scope X X X X
4297stats show-desc X X X X
4298stats show-legends X X X X
4299stats show-node X X X X
4300stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4302stick match - - X X
4303stick on - - X X
4304stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004305stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004306stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004307tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004308tcp-check connect X - X X
4309tcp-check expect X - X X
4310tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004311tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004312tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004313tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004314tcp-check set-var X - X X
4315tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004316tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4317tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4318tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4319tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4320tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4321tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004322timeout check X - X X
4323timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004324timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004325timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004326timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4327timeout http-request X X X X
4328timeout queue X - X X
4329timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004330timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004331timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004332timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004333transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004334unique-id-format X X X -
4335unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004336use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004337use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004338use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004339------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4340 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043434.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4344---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345
4346This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4347
4348
4349acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4350 Declare or complete an access list.
4351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004352 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4353
4354 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4355 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4356 using it.
4357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004358 Example:
4359 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4360 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4361 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004363 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004364
4365
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004366backlog <conns>
4367 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4369 yes | yes | yes | no
4370 Arguments :
4371 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4372 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004373 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004374
4375 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4376 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4377 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4378 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4379 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4380 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4381 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4382 backlog parameter.
4383
4384 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4385 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4386 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4387
4388 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4389
4390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004392balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004393 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 yes | no | yes | yes
4396 Arguments :
4397 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4398 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4399 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4400 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4401
4402 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4403 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4404 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4405 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004406 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004407 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004408 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4409 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4410 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4411 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4412 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4413 it, so that you don't worry.
4414
4415 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4416 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4417 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4418 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4419 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4420 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4421 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4422 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004423
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004424 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4425 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4426 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4427 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4428 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4429 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4430 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004431 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4432 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4433 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004434
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004435 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004436 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004437 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4438 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004439 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004440 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4441 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4442 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4443 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4444 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004445 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4446 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4447 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4448 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4449 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4450 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004451
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004452 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4453 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4454 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4455 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4456 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4457 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4458 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4459 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4460 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4461 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4462 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4463 changed using "hash-type".
4464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004465 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4466 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4467 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4468 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4469 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4470 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4471 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4472 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004473 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004474 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004475 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4476 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004477 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004478
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004479 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4480 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4481 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4482 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4483 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4484 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4485 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4486 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4487 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4488 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4489 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4490 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004491
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004492 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004493 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4494 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4495 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4496 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4497 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4498 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4499 URIs start with a leading "/".
4500
4501 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4502 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4503 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4504 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4505
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004506 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4507 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4508 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004509 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4510 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004513 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4514
4515 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004516 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4517 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004518 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4519 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4520 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4521 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004522 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004523 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4524 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004525
4526 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4527 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4528 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4529 server will receive the request.
4530
4531 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4532 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4533 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4534 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4535 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004536 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4537 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004538 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4539 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004540
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004541 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4542 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4543 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4544 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4545 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004547 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004548 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4549 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4550 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4551
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004552 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4553 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004554 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4555 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004556
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004557 random
4558 random(<draws>)
4559 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004560 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4561 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4562 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4563 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004564 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4565 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4566 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4567 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4568 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4569 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4570 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4571 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4572 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4573 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4574 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4575 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4576 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4577 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4578 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4579 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4580 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4581 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4582 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4583 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004584
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004585 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004586 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004587 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4588 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004589 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004590 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4591 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4592 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004593 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004594 used instead.
4595
4596 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4597 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4598 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004599 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004600
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004601 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4602 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004603 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4604 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004606 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004607 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4608 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004609
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004610 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4611 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4612 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004613
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004614 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004615 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004616 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4617 NTLM relies on.
4618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004619 Examples :
4620 balance roundrobin
4621 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004622 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004623 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4624 balance hdr(host)
4625 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004626 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4627 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4628 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004629
4630 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4631 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004633 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004634 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4635 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4636 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004637 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004638
4639 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4640 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4641 defaults to 16 kB.
4642
4643 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4644 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4645
4646 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4647 Round Robin.
4648
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004649 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004650 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4651 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4652 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4653
4654 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4655
4656 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004657 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004658 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4659 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4660 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004661
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004662 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004663
4664
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004665bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4666bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004667 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4669 no | yes | yes | no
4670 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004671 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4672 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4673 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4674 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004675 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4676 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4677 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4678 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4679 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004680 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4681 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4682 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4683 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4684 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4685 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004686 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004687 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4688 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004689 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004690 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4691 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004692 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004693 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4694 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004695 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004696 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004697 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4698 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4699 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004700 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4701 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4702 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4703 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004704 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01004705 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
4706 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.conn-owner" on
4707 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
4708 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
4709 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
4710 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
4711 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004712 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01004713 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
4714 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004715
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004716 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4717 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4718 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004719
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004720 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4721 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004722 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4723 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4724 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004725 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4726 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4727 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4728 the range.
4729
4730 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4731 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4732 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4733 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4734 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4735 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4736 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004737 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004738 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004739
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004740 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004741 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004742 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4743 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4744 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4745 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4746 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4747 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004749 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4750 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4751 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4752 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004754 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4755 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4756 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4757 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4758 in a frontend.
4759
4760 Example :
4761 listen http_proxy
4762 bind :80,:443
4763 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004764 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004765
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004766 listen http_https_proxy
4767 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004768 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004769
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004770 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4771 bind ipv6@:80
4772 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4773 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4774
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004775 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004776 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004777
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004778 listen h3_quic_proxy
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004779 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt alpn h3
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004780
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004781 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4782 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4783 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4784 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4785 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4786
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004787 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004788 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004789
4790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004791capture cookie <name> len <length>
4792 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 no | yes | yes | no
4795 Arguments :
4796 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4797 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4798 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4799 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004800 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004801
4802 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4803 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4804 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4805 right if it exceeds <length>.
4806
4807 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4808 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4809 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4810 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4811
4812 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4813 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4814 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4815
4816 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4817 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4818 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004819 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4820 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4821 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004822
4823 Example:
4824 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4825
4826 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004827 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004828
4829
4830capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004831 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4833 no | yes | yes | no
4834 Arguments :
4835 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004836 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004837 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4838 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4839 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4840
4841 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4842 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4843 it exceeds <length>.
4844
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004845 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004846 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4847 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004848 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4849 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4850 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4851 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004852 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004853 environments to find where the request came from.
4854
4855 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4856 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4857 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4858 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004859
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004860 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4861 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4862 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4863 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4864 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004865
4866 Example:
4867 capture request header Host len 15
4868 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004869 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004871 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004872 about logging.
4873
4874
4875capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004876 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 no | yes | yes | no
4879 Arguments :
4880 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004881 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004882 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4883 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4884 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4885
4886 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4887 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4888 it exceeds <length>.
4889
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004890 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004891 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4892 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4893 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004894 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4895 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4896 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4897 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004898
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004899 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4900 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4901 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4902 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4903 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004904
4905 Example:
4906 capture response header Content-length len 9
4907 capture response header Location len 15
4908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004909 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004910 about logging.
4911
4912
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004913clitcpka-cnt <count>
4914 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4915 the connection on the client side.
4916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4917 yes | yes | yes | no
4918 Arguments :
4919 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4920
4921 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4922 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004923 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4924 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004925
4926 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4927
4928
4929clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4930 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4931 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4932 client side.
4933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | no
4935 Arguments :
4936 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4937 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4938 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4939 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4940
4941 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4942 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004943 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4944 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004945
4946 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4947
4948
4949clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4950 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | yes | yes | no
4953 Arguments :
4954 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4955 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4956 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4957 document.
4958
4959 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4960 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004961 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4962 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004963
4964 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4965
4966
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004967compression algo <algorithm> ...
4968compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004969 Enable HTTP compression.
4970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 yes | yes | yes | yes
4972 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004973 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4974 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004975
4976 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004977 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4978 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4979 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004980
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004981 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004982 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004983
4984 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4985 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4986 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4987 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4988 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004989 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004990
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004991 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4992 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4993 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4994 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4995 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4996 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4997 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004998 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004999
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005000 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005001 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005002 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005003 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005004 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005005 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005006 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005007
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005008 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005009 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5010 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005011 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005012 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005013 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5014 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5015 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5016 "multipart"
5017 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5018 header
5019 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5020 and later
5021 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5022 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005023 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005024
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005025 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005026
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005027 Examples :
5028 compression algo gzip
5029 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005030
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005031 See also : "compression offload"
5032
5033compression offload
5034 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 no | yes | yes | yes
5037
5038 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5039 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5040 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5041 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5042 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5043 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5044 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5045 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5046 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5047 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5048 then be used for such scenarios.
5049
5050 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5051 option is ignored.
5052
5053 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005054
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005055cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005056 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5057 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005058 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005059 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5061 yes | no | yes | yes
5062 Arguments :
5063 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5064 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5065 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5066 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5067 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5068 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005069 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005070 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5071 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5072
5073 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005074 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005075 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5076 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5077 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5078 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005079 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5080 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005081 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005082 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5083 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005084
5085 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005086 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005087
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005088 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005089 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005090 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005091 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005092 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5093 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5094 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5095 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5096 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5097 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5098 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005099
5100 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5101 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5102 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5103 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5104 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5105 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5106 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5107 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5108 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005109 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005110 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5111 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5112 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005113
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005114 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5115 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5116 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005117 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5118 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5119 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5120 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005121 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5122 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5123 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005124
5125 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5126 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5127 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5128 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5129 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5130 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5131 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5132 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5133 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5134
5135 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5136 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5137 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5138 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5139 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5140 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5141 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5142 persistence cookie in the cache.
5143 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5144
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005145 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5146 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005147 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005148 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5149 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005150 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005151 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5152 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5153 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5154 they logout.
5155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005156 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005157 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5158 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5159 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005161 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005162 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5163 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5164 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5165 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5166 this attribute.
5167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005168 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005169 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005170 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5171 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5172 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5173 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5174 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5175 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005176
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005177 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5178 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5179 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5180 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5181 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5182 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5183 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5184 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005185 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005186 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5187 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5188 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5189 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5190 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5191 the site.
5192
5193 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5194 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5195 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5196 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5197 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5198 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5199 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5200 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5201 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5202 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5203 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5204 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5205 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005206 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005207 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5208 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5209
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005210 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5211 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5212 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5213 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5214 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5215 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5216
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005217 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005218 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5219 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5220 repeated.
5221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005222 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5223 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5224 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5225 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005227 Examples :
5228 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5229 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5230 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005231 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005232
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005233 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005234
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005235
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005236declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5237 Declares a capture slot.
5238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5239 no | yes | yes | no
5240 Arguments:
5241 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5242
5243 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5244 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5245 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5246 for use in the response.
5247
5248 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005249 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005250 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5251
5252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005253default-server [param*]
5254 Change default options for a server in a backend
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | no | yes | yes
5257 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005258 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5259 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5260 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5261 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005262
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005263 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005264 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5265
5266 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005267
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005269default_backend <backend>
5270 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5272 yes | yes | yes | no
5273 Arguments :
5274 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5275
5276 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5277 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5278 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5279 will catch all undetermined requests.
5280
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005281 Example :
5282
5283 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5284 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5285 default_backend dynamic
5286
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005287 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005289
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005290description <string>
5291 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5293 no | yes | yes | yes
5294 Arguments : string
5295
5296 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5297 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5298 it describes.
5299 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5300
5301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005302disabled
5303 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5305 yes | yes | yes | yes
5306 Arguments : none
5307
5308 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5309 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5310 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5311 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5312 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5313 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5314 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5315
5316 See also : "enabled"
5317
5318
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005319dispatch <address>:<port>
5320 Set a default server address
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005323 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005324
5325 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5326 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5327 during start-up.
5328
5329 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5330 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5331 possible with normal servers.
5332
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005333 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005334 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5335 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5336 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5337 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5338
5339 See also : "server"
5340
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005341
5342dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5343 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | no | yes | yes
5346 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5347
5348 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005349 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005350 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5351 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005352 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005353 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005355enabled
5356 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 yes | yes | yes | yes
5359 Arguments : none
5360
5361 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5362 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5363
5364 See also : "disabled"
5365
5366
5367errorfile <code> <file>
5368 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5370 yes | yes | yes | yes
5371 Arguments :
5372 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005373 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005374 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005375
5376 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005377 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005378 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005379 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5380 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005381
5382 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5383 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5384 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5385
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005386 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5387
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005388 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5389 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5390 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5391 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5392 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5393 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5394 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5395 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5396 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005398 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5399 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5400 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005401 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005402 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5403
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005404 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005405
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005406 Example :
5407 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005408 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005409 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5410 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5411
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005412
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005413errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5414 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5415 section.
5416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5417 yes | yes | yes | yes
5418 Arguments :
5419 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5420
5421 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005422 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005423 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5424 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005425
5426 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5427 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5428 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5429 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5430 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005431 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005432 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5433
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005434 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5435 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005436
5437 Example :
5438 errorfiles generic
5439 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5440
5441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005442errorloc <code> <url>
5443errorloc302 <code> <url>
5444 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5446 yes | yes | yes | yes
5447 Arguments :
5448 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005449 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005450 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005451
5452 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5453 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5454 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5455 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005456 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005457
5458 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5459 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5460 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5461
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005462 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5463
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005464 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5465 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5466 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5467 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005468 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005469 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5470 request.
5471
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005472 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005473
5474
5475errorloc303 <code> <url>
5476 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5478 yes | yes | yes | yes
5479 Arguments :
5480 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005481 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005482 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005483
5484 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5485 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5486 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5487 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005488 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005489
5490 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5491 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5492 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5493
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005494 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5495
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005496 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5497 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5498 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5499 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005500 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005501
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005502 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005503
5504
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005505email-alert from <emailaddr>
5506 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005507 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5509 yes | yes | yes | yes
5510
5511 Arguments :
5512
5513 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5514
5515 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5516 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5517
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005518 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005519 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5520 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005521
5522
5523email-alert level <level>
5524 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5525 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5527 yes | yes | yes | yes
5528
5529 Arguments :
5530
5531 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5532 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5533 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5534
5535 By default level is alert
5536
5537 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5538 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5539 for the proxy.
5540
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005541 Alerts are sent when :
5542
5543 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5544 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5545 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5546 is notice or lower
5547 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5548 and a health check status update occurs
5549
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005550 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5551 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005552 section 3.6 about mailers.
5553
5554
5555email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5556 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5558 yes | yes | yes | yes
5559
5560 Arguments :
5561
5562 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5563
5564 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5565 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5566
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005567 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5568 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005569
5570
5571email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5572 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5573 mailers.
5574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | yes | yes | yes
5576
5577 Arguments :
5578
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005579 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005580
5581 By default the systems hostname is used.
5582
5583 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5584 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5585 for the proxy.
5586
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005587 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5588 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005589
5590
5591email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005592 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005593 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5595 yes | yes | yes | yes
5596
5597 Arguments :
5598
5599 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5600
5601 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5602 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5603
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005604 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005605 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5606
5607
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005608error-log-format <string>
5609 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5611 yes | yes | yes | no
5612
5613 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5614 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5615 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5616 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005617 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5618
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005619 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5620 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5621 string in depth.
5622
5623 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5624 directives.
5625
5626
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005627force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5628 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5629 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005630 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005631
5632 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5633 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5634 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5635 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5636 marked down for maintenance operations.
5637
5638 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5639 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5640 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5641 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5642 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5643 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5644 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5645 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5646 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5647
5648 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5649 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5650 is used.
5651
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005652 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005653 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005654
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005655
5656filter <name> [param*]
5657 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5659 no | yes | yes | yes
5660 Arguments :
5661 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5662 referenced in section 9.
5663
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005664 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005665 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005666 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5667 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005668
5669 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5670 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5671
5672 Example:
5673 listen
5674 bind *:80
5675
5676 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5677 filter compression
5678 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5679
5680 compression algo gzip
5681 compression offload
5682
5683 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5684
5685 See also : section 9.
5686
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005687
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005688fullconn <conns>
5689 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 yes | no | yes | yes
5692 Arguments :
5693 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5694 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5695
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005696 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005697 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005698 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5700 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5701 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5702 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5703 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005704 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005705
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005706 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005707 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005708 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5709 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5710 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005712 Example :
5713 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5714 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5715 # connections.
5716 backend dynamic
5717 fullconn 10000
5718 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5719 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5720
5721 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5722
5723
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005724hash-balance-factor <factor>
5725 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5727 yes | no | no | yes
5728 Arguments :
5729 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5730 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005731 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005732
5733 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5734 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5735 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5736 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5737 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5738 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5739 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5740
5741 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5742 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5743 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5744 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5745 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5746
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005747 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5748 consistent hashing mechanism.
5749
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005750 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5751
5752
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005753hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005754 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | no | yes | yes
5757 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005758 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5759 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005760
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005761 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5762 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5763 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5764 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5765 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5766 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5767 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5768 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5769 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5770 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005771
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005772 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5773 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5774 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5775 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5776 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5777 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5778 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5779 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5780 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5781 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5782 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5783 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5784 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005785 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5786 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005787
5788 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5789
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005790 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005791 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5792 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5793 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005794 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5795 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5796 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005797
5798 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5799 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005800 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5801 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5802 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5803 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5804
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005805 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005806 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5807 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5808 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5809 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5810 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5811 parameter.
5812
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005813 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5814 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5815 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5816 used on strings.
5817
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005818 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5819
5820 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5821 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5822 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5823 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5824 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5825 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5826 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5827 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5828 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5829 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5830 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5831 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005832
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005833 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5834 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5835 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005836
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005837 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005838
5839
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005840http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5841 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5842 ones).
5843
5844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005845 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005846
5847 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5848 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5849 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5850 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5851 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5852 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5853
5854 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5855 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5856 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5857
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005858 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5859 supported:
5860 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5861 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005862 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005863 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005864 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005865 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005866 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5867 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005868 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
5869 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
5870 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
5871 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5872 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005873 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005874 - set-log-level <level>
5875 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005876 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005877 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5878 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005879 - strict-mode { on | off }
5880 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5881
5882 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005883
5884 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5885 instance.
5886
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005887 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5888 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5889 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5890 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5891 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5892 a defaults section defining such rules.
5893
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005894 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5895 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5896 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5897
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005898 Example:
5899 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5900 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5901 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5902
5903http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5904
5905 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005906 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5907 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005908
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01005909http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5910
5911 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5912 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
5913
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005914http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5915
5916 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5917 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5918 complete description.
5919
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005920http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5921
5922 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
5923 del-acl" for a complete description.
5924
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005925http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005926
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005927 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5928 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005929
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005930http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5931
5932 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5933 del-map" for a complete description.
5934
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005935http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5936 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5937
5938 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5939
5940 Example:
5941 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5942
5943 # applied to:
5944 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5945
5946 # outputs:
5947 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5948
5949 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5950
5951http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5952 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5953
5954 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5955
5956 Example:
5957 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5958
5959 # applied to:
5960 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5961
5962 # outputs:
5963 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5964
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005965http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5966http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5967http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5968
5969 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
5970 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
5971 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
5972 description.
5973
5974http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5975 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5976http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5977 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5978
5979 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
5980 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
5981 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
5982
5983http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5984
5985 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
5986 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
5987
5988http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5989
5990 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5991 set-map" for a complete description.
5992
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005993http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5994
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005995 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5996 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5997 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5998 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005999
6000http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6001 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6002
6003 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006004 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006005 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006006
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006007http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6008http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006009
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006010 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6011 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6012 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006013
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006014http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006015
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006016 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6017 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006018
6019http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6020
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006021 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6022 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006023
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006024
6025http-check comment <string>
6026 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6027 it fails.
6028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6029 yes | no | yes | yes
6030
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006031 Arguments :
6032 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6033 rule fails.
6034
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006035 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6036 user-friendly error reporting.
6037
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006038 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006039 "http-check expect".
6040
6041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006042http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6043 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006044 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006045 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6047 yes | no | yes | yes
6048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006049 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006050 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6051
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006052 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006053 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006054
6055 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6056 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6057 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6058 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6059
6060 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6061
6062 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6063
6064 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6065
6066 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6067
6068 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6069
6070 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6071 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6072 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6073 is used.
6074
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006075 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6076 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6077 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6078 haproxy -vv.
6079
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006080 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6081
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006082 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6083 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6084 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6085 different ports or with different servers.
6086
6087 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6088 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6089 the port with a "http-check connect".
6090
6091 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6092 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6093 do.
6094
6095 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6096 unset-var or comment rules.
6097
6098 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006099 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6100 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6101 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6102 option httpchk
6103
6104 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006105 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006106 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006107 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006108 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006109 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006110
6111 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6112
6113 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006114
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006116http-check disable-on-404
6117 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006119 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006120 Arguments : none
6121
6122 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6123 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6124 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6125 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6126 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6127 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6128 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6129 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006130 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6131 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006132 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6133 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6134 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006135
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006136 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006137
6138
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006139http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006140 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6141 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6142 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006143 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006145 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006146
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006147 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006148 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6149
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006150 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6151 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6152 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6153 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6154 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6155 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6156 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6157 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6158 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6159 result is always conclusive.
6160
6161 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6162 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6163 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006164 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6165 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006166 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6167 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006168 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6169 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6170 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006171
6172 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6173 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006174 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6175 supported :
6176 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6177 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006178 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6179 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6180 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6181 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6182 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006183
6184 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6185 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006186 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6187 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6188 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6189 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006190 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6191
6192 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6193 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6194 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6195 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6196
6197 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6198 informational message reported in logs if an error
6199 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6200 log-format string.
6201
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006202 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006203 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6204 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006205 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6206 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6207 details on the supported keywords.
6208
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006209 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6210 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6211 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6212 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006213
6214 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6215 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6216 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6217 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6218 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6219
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006220 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6221 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6222 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6223 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6224 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6225 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6226 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006227
6228 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006229 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006230 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6231 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6232 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6233 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6234
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006235 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6236 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006237 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6238 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6239 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6240 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6241 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6242 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6243 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6244 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006245 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6246 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6247 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6248 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6249 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6250 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6251 insensitive on the header names.
6252
6253 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6254 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6255 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6256 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6257 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6258 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006259
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006260 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006261 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006262 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6263 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6264 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6265 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6266 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006267 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006268 trace).
6269
6270 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006271 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006272 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6273 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6274 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6275 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6276 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006277 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006278
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006279 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6280 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6281 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6282 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6283 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6284 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6285
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006286 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006287 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006288 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6289 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6290 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6291 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6292 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6293 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6294
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006295 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6296 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6297 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6298 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6299 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006300
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006301 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6302 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6303
6304 Examples :
6305 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006306 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006307
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006308 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6309 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006311 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006312 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006313
6314 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006315 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006316
6317 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006318 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006319
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006320 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006321 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006322
6323
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006324http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006325 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6326 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006327 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6328 health checks.
6329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6330 yes | no | yes | yes
6331 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006332 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6333
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006334 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6335 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6336 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6337 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6338 to invent non-standard ones.
6339
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006340 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6341 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6342 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6343 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6344
6345 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6346 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6347 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6348 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006349
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006350 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006351 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006352 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006353 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6354 to add it.
6355
6356 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6357 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6358 to the log-format rules.
6359
6360 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6361 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6362 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006363
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006364 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6365 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6366 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6367 request.
6368
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006369 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6370 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6371 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006372 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6373 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6374 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6375 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006376 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006377
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006378 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006379 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6380 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006381
6382 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6383 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6384 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6385 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6386 configured request authority.
6387
6388 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6389 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006390
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006391 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006392
6393
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006394http-check send-state
6395 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6397 yes | no | yes | yes
6398 Arguments : none
6399
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006400 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006401 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006402 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6403 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6404 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006405
6406 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6407 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6408 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6409 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6410 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006411 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6412 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6413 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6414
6415 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6416 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6417 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6418
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006419 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6420 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6421 checked in multiple backends.
6422
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006423 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006424 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6425
6426 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6427 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6428 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6429 one fails.
6430
6431 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6432 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6433 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6434
6435 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6436 server's queue.
6437
6438 Example of a header received by the application server :
6439 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6440 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6441
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006442 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6443 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006444
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006445
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006446http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6447http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006448 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6450 yes | no | yes | yes
6451
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006452 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006453 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6454 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6455 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6456 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6457 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6458 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6459 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6460 and '-'.
6461
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006462 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6463 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006464 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006465 conditions.
6466
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006467 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6468
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006469 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6470 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6471
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006472 Examples :
6473 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006474 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006475
6476
6477http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006478 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | no | yes | yes
6481
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006482 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006483 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6484 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6485 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6486 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6487 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6488 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6489 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6490 and '-'.
6491
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006492 Examples :
6493 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006496http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6497 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6498 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6499 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6500 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 yes | yes | yes | yes
6503 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006504 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006505 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006506 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006507 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006508
6509 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6510 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6511 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6512 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6513
6514 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6515 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6516 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6517 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6518
6519 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6520 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6521 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6522 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6523 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6524 chroot is performed.
6525
6526 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6527 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6528 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6529 considered.
6530
6531 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6532 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6533 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6534 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6535 considered as a raw string.
6536
6537 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6538 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6539 "content-type".
6540
6541 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6542 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6543 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6544 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6545 evaluated as a log-format string.
6546
6547 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6548 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6549 argument to "content-type".
6550
6551 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6552 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6553 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6554 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6555
6556 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6557 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6558 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6559 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6560 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6561 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6562 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6563 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6564
6565 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6566 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6567 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6568
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006569 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6570 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6571 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6572 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6573 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6574
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006575 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6576 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6577
6578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006579http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006580 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6581
6582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006583 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006584
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006585 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6586 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6587 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6588 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6589 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006590
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006591 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6592 supported:
6593 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6594 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6595 - allow
6596 - auth [realm <realm>]
6597 - cache-use <name>
6598 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6599 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6600 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6601 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6602 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6603 - disable-l7-retry
6604 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6605 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6606 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6607 - redirect <rule>
6608 - reject
6609 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6610 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6611 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6612 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6613 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6614 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6615 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6616 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6617 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6618 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6619 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01006620 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006621 - set-dst <expr>
6622 - set-dst-port <expr>
6623 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6624 - set-log-level <level>
6625 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6626 - set-mark <mark>
6627 - set-method <fmt>
6628 - set-nice <nice>
6629 - set-path <fmt>
6630 - set-pathq <fmt>
6631 - set-priority-class <expr>
6632 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6633 - set-query <fmt>
6634 - set-src <expr>
6635 - set-src-port <expr>
6636 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6637 - set-tos <tos>
6638 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006639 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6640 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006641 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01006642 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006643 - strict-mode { on | off }
6644 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6645 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6646 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6647 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6648 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6649 - use-service <service-name>
6650 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6651 - wait-for-handshake
6652 - cache-use <name>
6653
6654 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006657
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006658 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6659 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6660 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6661 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6662 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6663 a defaults section defining such rules.
6664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 Example:
6666 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6667 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6668 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670 http-request allow if nagios
6671 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6672 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6673 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006675 Example:
6676 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6677 acl add path /addacl
6678 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6683 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006685 Example:
6686 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6687 acl setmap path /setmap
6688 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006690 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6693 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6696 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6701 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6702 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6703 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6704 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6705 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6706 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6707 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006709http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006711 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6712 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6713 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6714 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6715 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6716 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6717 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6718 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006722 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006723 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6728 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6729 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6730 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6731 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006732
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006733 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6734 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6735 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6736 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6737 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6738 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6739 instead.
6740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006741 Example:
6742 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6743 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006744
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006745http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006746
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006747 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6750 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006752 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6753 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6754 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6755 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6756 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6757 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6758 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6759 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6760 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6763 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6764 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006765 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6766
6767 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6768 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6769 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6770 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006772http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6775 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6776 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6777 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6778 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6779 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006780
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006781http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006782
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006783 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6784 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6785 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6786 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6787 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006788
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006789http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006791 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6792 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6793 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6794 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6795 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6796 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006797
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006798http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6799http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6800 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6801 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6802 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6803 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006804
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006805 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6806 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6807 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006808 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006809 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6810 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6811 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006812 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006813 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006814
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006815http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6816 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6817 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6818 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6819
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006820http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6821 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006822
6823 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6824 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6825 pointed by <resolvers>.
6826 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6827 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6828 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6829 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6830 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6831 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6832 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6833 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6834 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6835 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006836 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6837 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006838
6839 Example:
6840 resolvers mydns
6841 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6842 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6843 timeout retry 1s
6844 hold valid 10s
6845 hold nx 3s
6846 hold other 3s
6847 hold obsolete 0s
6848 accepted_payload_size 8192
6849
6850 frontend fe
6851 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02006852 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006853 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6854
6855 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6856 # which mean DNS resolution error
6857 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6858
6859 default_backend be
6860
6861 backend b_503
6862 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6863 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6864 # 503 error page to end users
6865
6866 backend be
6867 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6868 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6869 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6870 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6871 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6872
6873 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6874 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6875
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006876http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6877
6878 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6879 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6880 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6881 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006882 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6883 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006884
6885 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6886
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006887http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006888http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006889http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006890http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006891http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006892http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006893http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006894http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6895http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006896
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006897 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6898
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006899 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006900 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6901 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6902 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6903 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006904
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006905 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6906 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6907 the supported backend.
6908
6909 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6910 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6911 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6912 number of segments in the path.
6913
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006914 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6915 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6916 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6917 when improperly combined.
6918
6919 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6920 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6921 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6922 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6923 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6924
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006925 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006926
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006927 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6928
6929 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6930 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6931
6932 Example:
6933 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6934
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006935 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6936
6937 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6938 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6939
6940 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6941 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6942
6943 Example:
6944 - /#foo -> /
6945
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006946 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6947 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006948
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006949 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6950 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6951
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006952 Example:
6953 - /. -> /
6954 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6955 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6956 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006957
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006958 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6959 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6960
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006961 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006962 their preceding segment.
6963
6964 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6965 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6966
6967 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6968 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006969
6970 Example:
6971 - /foo/../ -> /
6972 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6973 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6974 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006975 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006976 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006977 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006978
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006979 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6980 removed as well:
6981
6982 Example:
6983 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6984 - /bar/../../ -> /
6985
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006986 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6987 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006988
6989 Example:
6990 - // -> /
6991 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6992
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006993 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6994 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6995
6996 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6997 ".", "_", and "~".
6998
6999 Example:
7000 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7001 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7002 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7003 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7004
7005 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7006 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7007
7008 Example:
7009 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7010 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7011
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007012 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007013 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007014
7015 Example:
7016 - /%6f -> /%6F
7017 - /%zz -> /%zz
7018
7019 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7020 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7021
7022 Example:
7023 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7024
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007025 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007026 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7027 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7028
7029 Example:
7030 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7031 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7032 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007034http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007036 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7037 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7038 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7039 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7040 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007042http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007044 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7045 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7046 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7047 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007049http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7050 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007051
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007052 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007053 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7054 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7055 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7056 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7057 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007058
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007059 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7060 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7061 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7062 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7063 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007064
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007065 Example:
7066 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7067
7068 # applied to:
7069 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7070
7071 # outputs:
7072 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7073
7074 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007075
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007076 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7077
7078 # applied to:
7079 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007080
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007081 # outputs:
7082 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007083
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007084http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7085 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7086
7087 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7088 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007089 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7090 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7091 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007092
7093 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7094 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7095 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7096
7097 Example:
7098 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7099 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7100
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007101 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7102 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7103 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7104 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7105
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007106http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7107 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7108
7109 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7110 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7111 query-string are replaced.
7112
7113 Example:
7114 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7115 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7116
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007117http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7118 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7119
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007120 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7121 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7122 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7123 against.
7124
7125 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7126 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7127 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007128
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007129 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7130 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7131 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7132 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7133 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7134 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7135 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7136 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7137 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007138 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7139 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007140
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007141 Example:
7142 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7143 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007144
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007145 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7146 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007148http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007150
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007151 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7152 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7153 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7154 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007155
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007156 Example:
7157 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007158
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007159 # applied to:
7160 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007161
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007162 # outputs:
7163 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007164
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007165http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7166 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7167 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007168 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7170
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007171 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007172 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7173 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007174 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007175 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007176 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007177 are followed to create the response :
7178
7179 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7180 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7181 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7182 ignored.
7183
7184 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7185 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007186 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007187 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7188 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007189
7190 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7191 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7192 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007193 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007194 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007195
7196 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7197 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7198 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007199 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007200 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007201 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007202
7203 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7204 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7205 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7206 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7207 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7208 as a raw content.
7209
7210 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7211 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7212 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7213 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7214 considered as a raw string.
7215
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007216 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007217 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7218 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7219 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7220
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007221 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7222 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007223 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007224
7225 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7226
7227 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007228 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007229 if { path /ping }
7230
7231 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7232 if { path /favicon.ico }
7233
7234 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7235 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7236 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7237
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007238http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7239 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7240
7241 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7242 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7243 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7244 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7245 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7246 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7247 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7248 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7249 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7250
7251 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7252 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7253 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7254 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7255 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7256 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7257
7258 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7259 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7260 uploaded bytes, etc).
7261
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007262http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7263
7264 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7265 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7266 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7267 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7268 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7269 at this index.
7270 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7271 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007273http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7274http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007276 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7277 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7278 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007279
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007280http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7281 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7282 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7283 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7284 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7285 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7286 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7287 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7288 at this index.
7289 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7290 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7291
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007292http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007294
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007295 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7296 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7297 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7298 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007299
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007300http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7301 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7302
7303 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7304 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7305 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7306 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7307 agent name must be used.
7308
7309 Arguments:
7310 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7311
7312 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7313 configuration.
7314
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007315http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7316 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007317
7318 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7319 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7320 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7321 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7322 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7323 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7324 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7325 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7326
7327 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7328 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7329 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7330
7331 Arguments:
7332 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7333 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7334 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7335 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7336
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007337 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7338 bytes.
7339
7340 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7341 milliseconds.
7342
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007343 Example:
7344 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7345 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7346
7347 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007349http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007351 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7352 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7353 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7354 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7355 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007357 Arguments:
7358 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7359 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007361 Example:
7362 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7363 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007365 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7366 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007368http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007370 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7371 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7372 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007374 Arguments:
7375 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7376 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007378 Example:
7379 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7380 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007382 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7383 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7384 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007386http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007388 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7389 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7390 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7391 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7392 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007394 Example:
7395 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7396 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7397 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7398 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7399 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7400 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7401 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7402 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7403 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007405http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007407 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7408 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7409 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7410 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7411 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007413http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7414 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007416 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7417 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7418 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7419 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7420 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7421 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7422 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7423 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7424 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007426http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007427
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007428 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7429 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7430 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7431 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7432 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7433 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7434 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007435 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7436 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007438http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007440 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7441 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7442 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007444http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007446 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7447 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7448 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7449 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7450 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7451 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7452 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7453 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007455http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007457 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7458 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7459 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7460 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7461 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7462 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007464 Example :
7465 # prepend the host name before the path
7466 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007467
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007468http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7469
7470 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7471 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7472 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007474http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007476 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7477 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7478 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7479 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7480 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007482http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007484 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7485 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7486 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7487 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7488 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7489 values have higher priority.
7490 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7491 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7492 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7493 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7494 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007496http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007498 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7499 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7500 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7501 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7502 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7503 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7504 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007506 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007507
7508 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007509 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7510 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007512http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7513 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7514 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7515 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007516 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7517 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007518
7519 Arguments :
7520 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7521 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007522
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007523 See also "option forwardfor".
7524
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007525 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007526 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7527 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7528
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007529 # After the masking this will track connections
7530 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7531 http-request track-sc0 src
7532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007533 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7534 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7535
7536http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7537
7538 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7539 expression.
7540
7541 Arguments:
7542 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7543 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007544
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007545 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007546 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7547 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7548
7549 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7550 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7551 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7552
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007553http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7555
7556 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7557 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7558 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7559 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7560 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7561
7562 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7563 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7564 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7565 results.
7566
7567 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007568 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7569 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007571http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7572
7573 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7574 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7575 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7576 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7577 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7578 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7579 information from the request.
7580
7581 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7582
7583http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7584
7585 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7586 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007587 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7588 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7589 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7590 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7591 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007592 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7593
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007594http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7595http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007596
7597 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7598 inline.
7599
7600 Arguments:
7601 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7602 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7603 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7604 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7605 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7606 (request and response)
7607 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7608 processing
7609 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7610 processing
7611 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7612 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7613 and '_'.
7614
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007615 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7616 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007617 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007618 conditions.
7619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007620 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7621 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007622
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007623 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7624 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7625
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007626 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007627 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007628 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7629
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007630http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007631
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007632 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
7633 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
7634 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
7635 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
7636 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
7637
7638 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
7639 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
7640 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
7641 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
7642 session tables.
7643
7644 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
7645 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
7646 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
7647 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
7648 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
7649 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
7650 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007651
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007652http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007653
7654 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7655 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7656 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7657 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7658 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007659 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007660 processing.
7661
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007662 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007663 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7664 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7665 rules evaluation.
7666
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007667http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7668http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7669 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7670 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7671 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7672 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007673
7674 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7675 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7676 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007677 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7678 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7679 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7680 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7681 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7682 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007683 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007684 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7685 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7686 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007687 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007688 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7689 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7690 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7691 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7692 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007693
7694http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7695http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7696http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7697
7698 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7699 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01007700 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
7701 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
7702 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
7703 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007704 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7705 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7706 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7707 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7708 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7709 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7710 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7711
7712 Arguments :
7713 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7714 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7715 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7716 select which table entry to update the counters.
7717
7718 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7719 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7720 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7721 that table until the session ends.
7722
7723 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7724 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7725 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7726 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7727 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7728 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7729 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7730 useful information.
7731
7732 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7733 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7734 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7735 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7736 checks that make use of it.
7737
7738http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7739
7740 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007741
7742 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007743 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007744
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007745http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7746
7747 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7748 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7749 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7750 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7751 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7752 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7753
7754 Arguments :
7755 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7756
7757 Example:
7758 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7759
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007760http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7761 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7762
7763 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7764 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7765 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7766 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7767 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7768 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7769 http-buffer-request".
7770
7771 Arguments :
7772
7773 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7774 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7775
7776 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007777 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007778 bytes.
7779
7780 Example:
7781 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7782
7783 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007785http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007786
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007787 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7788 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7789 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007790
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007792http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007793 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7794
7795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007796 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007797
7798 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7799 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7800 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7801 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7802 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7803 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7804
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007805 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7806 supported:
7807 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7808 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7809 - allow
7810 - cache-store <name>
7811 - capture <sample> id <id>
7812 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7813 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7814 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7815 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7816 - redirect <rule>
7817 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7818 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7819 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7820 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7821 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7822 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7823 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7824 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7825 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007826 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007827 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7828 - set-log-level <level>
7829 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7830 - set-mark <mark>
7831 - set-nice <nice>
7832 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7833 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007834 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7835 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01007836 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007837 - strict-mode { on | off }
7838 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7839 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7840 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7841 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7842 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7843
7844 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007846 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007847
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007848 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7849 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7850 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7851 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7852 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7853 a defaults section defining such rules.
7854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007855 Example:
7856 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007857
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007858 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007860 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7861 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007863 Example:
7864 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007866 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007868 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7869 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007870
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007871 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7872 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007873
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007874http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007875
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007876 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7877 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007879http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007881 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007882 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7883 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007885http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007887 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7888 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007889
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007890http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007891
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007892 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007893
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007894http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007896 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7897 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7898 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7899 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7900 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7901 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7902 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007904 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7905 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7906 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7907 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7908 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007909
7910 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7911 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7912 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7913 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007915http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007916
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007917 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7918 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007919
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007920http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007921
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007922 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7923 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007925http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007926
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007927 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7928 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007929
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007930http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7931http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7932 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7933 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7934 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7935 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007936
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007937 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7938 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7939 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007940 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007941 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7942 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7943 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007944 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007945 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007947http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007949 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7950 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7951 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7952 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7953 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7954 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007956http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7957 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007958
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007959 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7960 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007962 Example:
7963 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007965 # applied to:
7966 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007968 # outputs:
7969 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007971 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007973http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7974 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007975
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007976 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007977 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007979 Example:
7980 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007982 # applied to:
7983 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007985 # outputs:
7986 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007987
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007988http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7989 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7990 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007991 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007992 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7993
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007994 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7995 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7996 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007997
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007998http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007999http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8000http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008001
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008002 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8003 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8004 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8005 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008006
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008007http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008008 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008009http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8010 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008011
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008012 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8013 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
8014 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008015
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008016http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8017 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008018
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008019 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8020 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008021
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008022http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8023 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008024
8025 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8026 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8027 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008029http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008030
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008031 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8032 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8033 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8034 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008036http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8037
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008038 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8039 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008040
8041http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8042
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008043 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8044 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008045
8046http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8047
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008048 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8049 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8050 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008051
8052http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8053
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008054 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8055 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008056
8057http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8058 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8059
8060 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8061 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8062 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8063 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008064
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008065 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008066 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8067 http-response set-status 431
8068 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8069 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008071http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008073 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008074 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8075 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008076
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008077http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8078http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008079
8080 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008081 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8082 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008083
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008084http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008086 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8087 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008088 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8089 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008090
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008091http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008092
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008093 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8094 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008096http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8097http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8098http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008099
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008100 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8101 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8102 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008103
8104http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8105
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008106 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008107 about <var-name>.
8108
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008109http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8110 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8111
8112 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008113 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8114 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008115
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008116
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008117http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8118 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8119
8120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8121 yes | no | yes | yes
8122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008123 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008124 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8125 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8126 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008127
8128 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8129
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008130 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8131 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8132 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8133 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8134 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8135 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8136 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008137 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008138 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8139 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008140
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008141 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8142 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8143 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8144 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8145 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8146 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8147 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008148 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8149 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8150 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8151 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8152 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8153 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008154
8155 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8156 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8157 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8158 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8159 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8160 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8161 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8162 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008163 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008164 downsides of rare connection failures.
8165
8166 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8167 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8168 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8169 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8170 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8171 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008172 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008173 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8174 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8175 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8176 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8177 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8178
8179 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008180 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8181 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8182 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8183 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008184
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008185 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8186 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008187
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008188 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008189
8190 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8191 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8192 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8193
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008194 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8195 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8196 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8197 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8198 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8199 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8200 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8201 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8202 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8203 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8204 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8205
8206 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8207 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8208 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8209 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8210 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8211
8212 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8213 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008214
8215
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008216http-send-name-header [<header>]
8217 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8219 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008220 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008221 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8222
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008223 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8224 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8225 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8226 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8227 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8228 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8229 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8230 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8231 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8232 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8233 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8234 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8235 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8236 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8237 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8238 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008239
8240 See also : "server"
8241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008242id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008243 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8245 no | yes | yes | yes
8246 Arguments : none
8247
8248 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8249 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8250 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008251
8252
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008253ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8254 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008256 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008257
8258 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8259 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8260 and running).
8261
8262 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8263 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8264 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008265 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008266 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8267
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008268 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8269 "unless" condition is met.
8270
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008271 Example:
8272 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8273 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8274 ignore-persist if url_static
8275
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008276 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8277
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008278load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8279 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8281 yes | no | yes | yes
8282
8283 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8284 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8285 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008286 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008287 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008288 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8289 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8290 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008292 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008293 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008294 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008295
8296 Arguments:
8297 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8298 named "server-state-file".
8299
8300 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8301 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8302 name is used as a file name.
8303
8304 none don't load any stat for this backend
8305
8306 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008307 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8308 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8309 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008310 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008311 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008312
8313 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8314 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8315
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008316 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008317
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008318 global
8319 stats socket /tmp/socket
8320 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008321
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008322 defaults
8323 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008324
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008325 backend bk
8326 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8327 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008328
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008329
8330 Then one can run :
8331
8332 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8333
8334 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8335
8336 1
8337 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8338 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8339 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8340
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008341 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008342
8343 global
8344 stats socket /tmp/socket
8345 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8346
8347 defaults
8348 load-server-state-from-file local
8349
8350 backend bk
8351 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8352 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8353
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008354
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008355 Then one can run :
8356
8357 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8358
8359 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8360
8361 1
8362 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8363 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8364 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8365
8366 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8367 "show servers state"
8368
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008369
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008370log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008371log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008372 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008373no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008374 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8376 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008377
8378 Prefix :
8379 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8380 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8381 prefix does not allow arguments.
8382
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008383 Arguments :
8384 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8385 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8386 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8387 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8388 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8389 parameter.
8390
8391 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8392 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8393
8394 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8395 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8396 standard syslog port).
8397
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008398 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8399 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8400 standard syslog port).
8401
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008402 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8403 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8404 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008405 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008406
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008407 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8408 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8409 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8410 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8411 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8412 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8413 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8414 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8415 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8416 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8417 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8418 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008419 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008420 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8421 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8422 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008423 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8424 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008425
8426 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8427 and "fd@2", see above.
8428
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008429 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8430 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8431 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8432 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8433 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8434 having the logs instantly available.
8435
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008436 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8437 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8438 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8439
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008440 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8441 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008442
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008443 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8444 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8445 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8446 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8447 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8448 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8449 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8450 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8451 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8452 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008453 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008454
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008455 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8456 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8457 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8458 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8459 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8460
8461 <sample_size>
8462 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8463 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8464 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8465 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8466 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8467
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008468 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8469 one of the following :
8470
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008471 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8472 field is stripped. This is the default.
8473 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8474 rfc3164.
8475
8476 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008477 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8478
8479 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8480 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8481
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008482 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8483 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8484 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8485 designed to be used with a local log server.
8486
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008487 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8488 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8489 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8490 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8491 systemd logger consumes.
8492
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008493 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8494 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8495 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8496 used with a local log server.
8497
8498 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8499 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8500 designed to be used with a local log server.
8501
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008502 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8503 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8504 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8505 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8506
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008507 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8508
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008509 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8510 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8511 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8512
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008513 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8514 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8515 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8516 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008517
8518 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8519 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8520 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008521 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8522 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8523 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8524 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8525 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008526
8527 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8528
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008529 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8530 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8531 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008532
8533 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8534 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8535 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8536 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8537
8538 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8539 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008540
8541 Example :
8542 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008543 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8544 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8545 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008546 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008547 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8548 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008549 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008550
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008551
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008552log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008553 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8554 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8555 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008556
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008557 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8558 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8559 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8560 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8561 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008562 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8563 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008564
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008565 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8566 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008567
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008568log-format-sd <string>
8569 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8571 yes | yes | yes | no
8572
8573 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8574 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8575 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8576 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8577 which covers the log format string in depth.
8578
8579 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8580 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8581
8582 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8583 log format to "rfc5424".
8584
8585 Example :
8586 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8587
8588
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008589log-tag <string>
8590 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | yes | yes | yes
8593
8594 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8595 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008596 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008597 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8598 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8599 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8600 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8601 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8602 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008603
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008604max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8605 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8607 yes | no | yes | yes
8608
8609 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8610 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8611 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8612 servers.
8613
8614 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008615 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008616 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8617 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8618 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008619 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008620 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8621 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8622 picking a different server.
8623
8624 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8625 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8626 even if they have to be queued.
8627
8628 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8629 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8630
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008631max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8632 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8633 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8634 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008635
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008636maxconn <conns>
8637 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8639 yes | yes | yes | no
8640 Arguments :
8641 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8642 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8643 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8644 closes.
8645
8646 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008647 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008648 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8649 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008650 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8651 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8652 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8653 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008654
8655 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8656 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8657 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8658
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008659 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8660 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008662 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8663
8664
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008665mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008666 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8668 yes | yes | yes | yes
8669 Arguments :
8670 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8671 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8672 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8673 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8674
8675 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8676 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8677 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8678 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8679 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8680
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008681 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8682 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8683 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008684
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008685 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008686 defaults http_instances
8687 mode http
8688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008689
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008690monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008691 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8693 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008694 Arguments :
8695 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8696 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008697 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008698 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8699 backend and its backup.
8700
8701 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8702 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8703 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8704 servers in a list of backends.
8705
8706 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8707 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8708 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008709 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008710 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8711 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008712 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008713 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8714 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008715
8716 Example:
8717 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008718 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008719 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8720 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8721 monitor-uri /site_alive
8722 monitor fail if site_dead
8723
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008724 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008725
8726
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008727monitor-uri <uri>
8728 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8730 yes | yes | yes | no
8731 Arguments :
8732 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8733 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8734
8735 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8736 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8737 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8738 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8739 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8740 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8741 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8742 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8743
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008744 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008745 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8746 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008747 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8748 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8749 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008750 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8751 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8752 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008753
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008754 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8755 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8756 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8757 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8758
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008759 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008760 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008761 frontend www
8762 mode http
8763 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8764
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008765 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008767
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008768option abortonclose
8769no option abortonclose
8770 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8772 yes | no | yes | yes
8773 Arguments : none
8774
8775 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8776 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8777 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8778 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008779 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008780 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8781 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8782 encountered while delivering the response.
8783
8784 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8785 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8786 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8787 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8788 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8789 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008790 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008791 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008792 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008793 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8794 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8795 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008797 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8798 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008799 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8800 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8801 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8802 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8803 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8804 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008805 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008806
8807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8809
8810 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8811
8812
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008813option accept-invalid-http-request
8814no option accept-invalid-http-request
8815 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8817 yes | yes | yes | no
8818 Arguments : none
8819
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008820 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008821 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008822 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008823 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8824 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8825 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8826 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8827 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008828 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8829 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8830 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8831 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008832 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008833 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008834 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008835 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8836 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008837
8838 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8839 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8840 been confirmed.
8841
8842 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8843 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008844 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8845 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008846 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8847
8848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8850
8851 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8852 stats socket.
8853
8854
8855option accept-invalid-http-response
8856no option accept-invalid-http-response
8857 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8859 yes | no | yes | yes
8860 Arguments : none
8861
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008862 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008863 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008864 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008865 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8866 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8867 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8868 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8869 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008870 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8871 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8872 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008873
8874 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8875 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8876 been confirmed.
8877
8878 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8879 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8880 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8881 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8882
8883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8885
8886 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8887 stats socket.
8888
8889
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008890option allbackups
8891no option allbackups
8892 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8894 yes | no | yes | yes
8895 Arguments : none
8896
8897 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8898 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8899 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8900 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8901 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8902 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8903 order between the backup servers anymore.
8904
8905 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8906 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8907
8908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8910
8911
8912option checkcache
8913no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008914 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8916 yes | no | yes | yes
8917 Arguments : none
8918
8919 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8920 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008921 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008922 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8923 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008924 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008925
8926 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008927 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008928 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008929 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8930 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008931 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008932 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008933 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8934 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008935 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008936 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8937 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008938 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008939 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8940 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8941 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8942 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8943 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8944 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8945 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8946 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8947 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8948
8949 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008950 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8951 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8952 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8953 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008954
8955 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8956 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008957 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008958 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008959
8960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8962
8963
8964option clitcpka
8965no option clitcpka
8966 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8968 yes | yes | yes | no
8969 Arguments : none
8970
8971 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8972 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008973 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008974 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8975
8976 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8977 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8978 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8979 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8980
8981 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8982 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8983 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8984 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8985 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8986
8987 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8988
8989 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8990 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8991 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8992
8993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8995
8996 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8997
8998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008999option contstats
9000 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9002 yes | yes | yes | no
9003 Arguments : none
9004
9005 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9006 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9007 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009008 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009009 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9010 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9011 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9012 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9013 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009014
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009015option disable-h2-upgrade
9016no option disable-h2-upgrade
9017 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9018 connection.
9019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9020 yes | yes | yes | no
9021 Arguments : none
9022
9023 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9024 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9025 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9026 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009027 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9028 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9029 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9030 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9031 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9032 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009033
9034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009036
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009037option dontlog-normal
9038no option dontlog-normal
9039 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9041 yes | yes | yes | no
9042 Arguments : none
9043
9044 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9045 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9046 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9047 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9048 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9049 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9050 logged.
9051
9052 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9053 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9054 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009056 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009057 logging.
9058
9059
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009060option dontlognull
9061no option dontlognull
9062 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9064 yes | yes | yes | no
9065 Arguments : none
9066
9067 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9068 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9069 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9070 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9071 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9072 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009073 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9074 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9075 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009076
9077 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009078 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009079 would not be logged.
9080
9081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9083
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009084 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009085 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009086
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009087option forwarded [ proto ]
9088 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9089 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9090 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9091no option forwarded
9092 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9094 yes | no | yes | yes
9095 Arguments :
9096 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9097 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9098
9099 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9100 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9101
9102 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9103 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9104
9105 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9106 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9107
9108 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9109 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9110
9111
9112 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are loosing some request
9113 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9114
9115 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9116 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9117 underlying servers/applications.
9118 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9119 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9120 issues.
9121
9122 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9123 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9124 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9125
9126 The use of this single header allow to convey multiple informations
9127 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9128 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9129 values to an already existing header).
9130
9131 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9132 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9133
9134 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9135 behavior.
9136 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9137
9138 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
9139 option forwarded proto for
9140
9141 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9142 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9143 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9144 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9145 "unknown".
9146
9147 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9148 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9149 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9150 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9151
9152 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9153 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9154 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9155 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9156 "unknown".
9157
9158 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9159 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9160 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9161 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9162
9163 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9164 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9165 it will be ignored.
9166 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9167 otherwise it will be ignored.
9168
9169 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9170 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9171 it will be ignored.
9172 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9173 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9174
9175 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9176 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9177 it will be ignored.
9178 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9179 otherwise it will be ignored.
9180
9181 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9182 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9183 it will be ignored.
9184 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9185 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9186
9187 Examples :
9188 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9189 # Resulting header would look like this:
9190 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9191 backend www_default
9192 mode http
9193 option forwarded
9194 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9195
9196 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9197 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9198 # ip privacy is a concern)
9199 # Resulting header would look like this:
9200 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9201 backend www_host
9202 mode http
9203 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9204
9205 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9206 # Resulting header would look like this:
9207 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9208 backend www_custom
9209 mode http
9210 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9211
9212 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9213 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9214 # Resulting header would look like this:
9215 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9216 backend www_for_hide
9217 mode http
9218 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9219
9220 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009221
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009222option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009223 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9225 yes | yes | yes | yes
9226 Arguments :
9227 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9228 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009229 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009230 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009231
9232 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9233 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9234 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9235 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9236 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9237 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9238 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009239 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9240 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9241 possible that the client has already brought one.
9242
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009243 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009244 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009245 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009246 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009247 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009248 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009249
9250 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9251 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9252 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9253 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9254 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9255 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009256 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009257
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009258 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9259 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009260 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009261 are under the control of the end-user.
9262
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009263 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009264 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9265 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009266 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9267 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9268 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009269
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009270 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009271 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9272 frontend www
9273 mode http
9274 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9275
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009276 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9277 backend www
9278 mode http
9279 option forwardfor header X-Client
9280
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009281 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009282 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009283
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009284
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009285option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9286no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9287 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9289 yes | yes | yes | no
9290 Arguments : none
9291
9292 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9293 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9294 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9295 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9296 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9297 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9298 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9299
9300 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9301 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9302 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9303 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9304 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9305 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9306 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9307 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9308 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9309 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9310
9311 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9312
9313 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9314 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9315
9316 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9317 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9318
9319
9320option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9321no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9322 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9324 yes | no | yes | yes
9325 Arguments : none
9326
9327 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9328 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9329 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9330 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9331 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9332 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9333 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9334
9335 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9336 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9337 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9338 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9339 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9340 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9341 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9342 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9343 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9344 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9345
9346 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9347
9348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9350
9351 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9352 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9353
9354
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009355option http-buffer-request
9356no option http-buffer-request
9357 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9359 yes | yes | yes | yes
9360 Arguments : none
9361
9362 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9363 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9364 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9365 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9366 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9367 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009368 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9369 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9370 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9371 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009372
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009373 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9374 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009375
9376
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009377option http-ignore-probes
9378no option http-ignore-probes
9379 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | yes | yes | no
9382 Arguments : none
9383
9384 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9385 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9386 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9387 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9388 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9389 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9390 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9391 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9392 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009393 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9394 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009395 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9396
9397 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9398 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9399 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9400 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9401 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9402 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9403 are often the only way to detect them.
9404
9405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9407
9408 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9409
9410
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009411option http-keep-alive
9412no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009413 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9414 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9416 yes | yes | yes | yes
9417 Arguments : none
9418
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009419 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009420 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9421 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9422 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9423 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9424 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009425
9426 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9427 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009428 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9429 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9430 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9431 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9432 situations where this option may be useful :
9433
9434 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009435 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009436
9437 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9438 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9439
9440 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009441
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009442 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9443 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9444 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9445 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9446 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9447 not set.
9448
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009449 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009450 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009451
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009452 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009453 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009454
9455
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009456option http-no-delay
9457no option http-no-delay
9458 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9460 yes | yes | yes | yes
9461 Arguments : none
9462
9463 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9464 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9465 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9466 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9467 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9468 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9469 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009470 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009471 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9472 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9473 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9474 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9475 affected.
9476
9477 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9478 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9479 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9480 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9481 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9482 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9483 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9484 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9485 latency environments.
9486
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009487 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9488
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009489
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009490option http-pretend-keepalive
9491no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009492 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9493 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009495 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009496 Arguments : none
9497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009498 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009499 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9500 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9501 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9502 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9503 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9504 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009505
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009506 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009507 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009508 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009509 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009510 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009511 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9512
9513 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9514 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9515 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9516 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009517 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9518 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009519 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9520
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009521 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9522 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9523 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009524 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009525
9526 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9527 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9528
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009529 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009530 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009531
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009532option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9533 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9534 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9536 yes | yes | yes | yes
9537 Arguments :
9538 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9539 with no FastCGI application configured.
9540
9541 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9542 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9543 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9544
9545 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9546 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9547
9548 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9549 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9550 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9551 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9552 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9553 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9554 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9555 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9556
9557 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9558 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009559
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009560option http-server-close
9561no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009562 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9564 yes | yes | yes | yes
9565 Arguments : none
9566
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009567 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009568 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9569 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9570 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9571 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
9572 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
9573 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
9574 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
9575 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
9576 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
9577 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
9578 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
9579 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
9580 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009581
9582 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9583 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9584 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9585 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009586 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9587 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009588
9589 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9590 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009591 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9592 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9593 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009594
9595 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9596 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9597
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009598 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
9599 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009600
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009601option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009602no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009603 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9605 yes | yes | yes | no
9606 Arguments : none
9607
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009608 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009609 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9610 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9611 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9612 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9613 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009614 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009615
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009616 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009617 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009618 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9619 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9620 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009621
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009622 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9623 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9624 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9625 front of an existing proxy.
9626
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009627 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9628
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009629 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009630
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009631option httpchk
9632option httpchk <uri>
9633option httpchk <method> <uri>
9634option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009635 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9637 yes | no | yes | yes
9638 Arguments :
9639 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9640 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9641 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9642 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9643 ones.
9644
9645 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9646 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9647 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9648
9649 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9650 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9651 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009652 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009653
9654 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9655 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9656 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9657 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9658 the lack of any response.
9659
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009660 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9661 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9662 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9663 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9664
9665 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9666 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9667 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009668
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009669 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9670 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009671 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009672 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009673 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009674
9675 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009676 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9677 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9678 backend https_relay
9679 mode tcp
9680 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9681 http-check send hdr Host www
9682 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009683
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009684 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9685 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9686 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009687
9688
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009689option httpclose
9690no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009691 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9693 yes | yes | yes | yes
9694 Arguments : none
9695
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009696 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009697 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9698 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9699 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9700 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009701
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009702 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +01009703 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
9704 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009705 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
9706 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
9707 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009708
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009709 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009710 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
9711 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009712
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009713 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009714 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009715
9716 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9717 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9718
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009719 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009720
9721
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009722option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009723 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009725 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009726 Arguments :
9727 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9728 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9729 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009730 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009731 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009732
9733 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9734 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9735 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9736 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9737 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9738 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9739 ports.
9740
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009741 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9742 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009743
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009744 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009746 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009747
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009748option httpslog
9749 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9751 yes | yes | yes | no
9752
9753 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9754 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9755 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9756 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9757 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9758 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9759 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9760
9761 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9762
9763 See also : section 8 about logging.
9764
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009765
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009766option independent-streams
9767no option independent-streams
9768 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9770 yes | yes | yes | yes
9771 Arguments : none
9772
9773 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9774 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9775 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9776 receive data or not.
9777
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009778 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009779 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9780 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9781 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9782 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9783 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9784 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9785 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9786 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9787 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9788 socket buffers.
9789
9790 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9791 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9792 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9793 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9794 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9795
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009796 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009797
9798
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009799option ldap-check
9800 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9802 yes | no | yes | yes
9803 Arguments : none
9804
9805 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9806 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9807 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9808 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9809
9810 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9811 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9812
9813 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9814 configure it.
9815
9816 Example :
9817 option ldap-check
9818
9819 See also : "option httpchk"
9820
9821
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009822option external-check
9823 Use external processes for server health checks
9824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9825 yes | no | yes | yes
9826
9827 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9828 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9829 command".
9830
9831 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9832
9833 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9834
9835
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009836option idle-close-on-response
9837no option idle-close-on-response
9838 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9840 yes | yes | yes | no
9841 Arguments : none
9842
9843 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9844 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9845 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9846 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9847 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9848 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9849 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9850 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9851 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9852
9853 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9854 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9855
9856 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9857 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9858 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9859 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9860
9861 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9862 "hard-stop-after"
9863
9864
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009865option log-health-checks
9866no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009867 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9869 yes | no | yes | yes
9870 Arguments : none
9871
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009872 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9873 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9874 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009875
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009876 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9877 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9878 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9879 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9880 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9881
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009882 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009883 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009884
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009885 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9886 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9887 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009888
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009889
9890option log-separate-errors
9891no option log-separate-errors
9892 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9894 yes | yes | yes | no
9895 Arguments : none
9896
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009897 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009898 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9899 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9900 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9901 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9902 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9903 provides very important information.
9904
9905 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9906 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9907 error logs.
9908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009909 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009910 logging.
9911
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009912
9913option logasap
9914no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009915 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9917 yes | yes | yes | no
9918 Arguments : none
9919
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009920 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9921 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9922 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9923 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9924
9925 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9926 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9927 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9928 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9929 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009930 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009931 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9932 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9933 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9934 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009935 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009936
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009937 Examples :
9938 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9939 mode http
9940 option httplog
9941 option logasap
9942 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9943
9944 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9945 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9946 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9947 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009949 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009950 logging.
9951
9952
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009953option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009954 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9956 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009957 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009958 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9959 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009960 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9961 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009962
9963 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9964 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009965 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009966 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009967 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9968 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9969 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009970
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009971 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9972 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9973 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009974
9975 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009976 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009977 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9978 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9979 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9980 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9981 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9982 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9983 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9984
9985 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9986 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009987
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009988 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009989
9990 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9991 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9992 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9993 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009994 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009995 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009996
9997 See also: "option httpchk"
9998
9999
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010000option nolinger
10001no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010002 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10004 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010005 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010006
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010007 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010008 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10009 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10010 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10011 connections.
10012
10013 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10014 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010015 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10016 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10017 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10018 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10019 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10020 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10021 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10022 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10023 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10024 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10025 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10026 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10027 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010028
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010029 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10030 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10031 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10032 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10033 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010034
10035 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10036 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010037 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010038 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010039 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010040
10041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10043
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010044 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10045 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010046
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010047option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10048 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10050 yes | yes | yes | yes
10051 Arguments :
10052 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10053 matching <network>
10054 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10055 header name.
10056
10057 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10058 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10059 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10060 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10061 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10062 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10063 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10064 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10065 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10066 possible that the client has already brought one.
10067
10068 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10069 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10070 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10071 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10072 header and requires different one.
10073
10074 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10075 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10076 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010077 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10078 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10079 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10080 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10081 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010082
10083 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10084 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10085 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10086 both are defined.
10087
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010088 Examples :
10089 # Original Destination address
10090 frontend www
10091 mode http
10092 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10093
10094 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10095 backend www
10096 mode http
10097 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10098
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010099 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010100
10101
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010102option persist
10103no option persist
10104 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10105 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10106 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010107 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010108
10109 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10110 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10111 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10112 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10113 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10114 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10115 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10116 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10117 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10118 redirected to another valid server.
10119
10120 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10121 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10122
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010123 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010124
10125
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010126option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010127 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10129 yes | no | yes | yes
10130 Arguments :
10131 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10132 PostgreSQL server.
10133
10134 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10135 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10136 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10137 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10138
10139 See also: "option httpchk"
10140
10141
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010142option prefer-last-server
10143no option prefer-last-server
10144 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10145 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10146 yes | no | yes | yes
10147 Arguments : none
10148
10149 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010150 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010151 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10152 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010153 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010154 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010155 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010156 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10157 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010158 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010159 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010160 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10161 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10162 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010163 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10164 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10165 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010166
10167 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10168 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10169
10170 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10171
10172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010173option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010174option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010175no option redispatch
10176 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10177 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10178 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010179 Arguments :
10180 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10181 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10182 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010183 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010184 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010185 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010186 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10187 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10188 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010190
10191 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10192 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10193 be able to access the service anymore.
10194
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010195 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10196 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010197
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010198 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10199 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10200 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10201 following order:
10202
10203 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10204
10205 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10206 list, or
10207
10208 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10209
10210 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10211 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10212
10213 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10214 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10215 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10216 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10217
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010218 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010219 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10220 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010222 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10223 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10224
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010225 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010226
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010227
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010228option redis-check
10229 Use redis health checks for server testing
10230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10231 yes | no | yes | yes
10232 Arguments : none
10233
10234 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10235 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10236 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10237 find the "+PONG" response message.
10238
10239 Example :
10240 option redis-check
10241
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010242 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010243
10244
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010245option smtpchk
10246option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10247 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10249 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010250 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010251 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010252 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010253 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10254
10255 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10256 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10257 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10258
10259 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10260 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10261 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10262 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10263 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10264 dead server.
10265
10266 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10267 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010268 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010269 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10270
10271 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10272 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10273 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10274 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010275 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010276
10277 Example :
10278 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10279
10280 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010283option socket-stats
10284no option socket-stats
10285
10286 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10288 yes | yes | yes | no
10289
10290 Arguments : none
10291
10292
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010293option splice-auto
10294no option splice-auto
10295 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10297 yes | yes | yes | yes
10298 Arguments : none
10299
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010300 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010301 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010302 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010303 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010304 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010305 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10306 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10307 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10308 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10309
10310 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10311 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10312 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10313 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10314 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10315 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10316 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10317 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10318 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10319 keyword.
10320
10321 Example :
10322 option splice-auto
10323
10324 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10325 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10326
10327 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10328 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10329
10330
10331option splice-request
10332no option splice-request
10333 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10335 yes | yes | yes | yes
10336 Arguments : none
10337
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010338 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010339 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010340 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10341 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10342 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10343 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10344
10345 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10346
10347 Example :
10348 option splice-request
10349
10350 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10351 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10352
10353 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10354 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10355
10356
10357option splice-response
10358no option splice-response
10359 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10361 yes | yes | yes | yes
10362 Arguments : none
10363
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010364 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010365 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010366 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10367 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10368 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10369 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10370
10371 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10372
10373 Example :
10374 option splice-response
10375
10376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10378
10379 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10380 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10381
10382
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010383option spop-check
10384 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010386 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010387 Arguments : none
10388
10389 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10390 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10391 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10392 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10393
10394 Example :
10395 option spop-check
10396
10397 See also : "option httpchk"
10398
10399
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010400option srvtcpka
10401no option srvtcpka
10402 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10404 yes | no | yes | yes
10405 Arguments : none
10406
10407 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10408 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010409 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010410 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10411
10412 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10413 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10414 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10415 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10416
10417 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10418 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10419 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10420 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10421 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10422
10423 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10424
10425 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10426 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10427 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10428
10429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10431
10432 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10433
10434
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010435option ssl-hello-chk
10436 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10438 yes | no | yes | yes
10439 Arguments : none
10440
10441 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10442 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10443 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10444 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10445 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10446 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10447 hello message.
10448
10449 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10450 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10451 messages, which is appreciable.
10452
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010453 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010454 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10455 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010456
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010457 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10458
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010459
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010460option tcp-check
10461 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10463 yes | no | yes | yes
10464
10465 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10466 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10467
10468 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10469 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10470 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10471
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010472 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010473 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10474 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10475 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10476 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10477 only.
10478
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010479 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010480 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010481 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10482 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10483 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10484
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010485 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010486 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10487 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010488 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010489 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10490 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10491 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10492 the respective protocols.
10493 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010494 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010495
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010496 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010497
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010498 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10499 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10500 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10501 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010502
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010503 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10504 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10505 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010506
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010507
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010508 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010509 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010510 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010511 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010512
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010513 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010514 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010515 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010516
10517 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10518 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010519 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010520 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010521 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010522 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010523 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010524 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010525 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10526 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010527 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010528 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10529 tcp-check expect string +OK
10530
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010531 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010532 (send many headers before analyzing)
10533 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010534 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010535 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10536 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10537 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10538 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010539 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010540
10541
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010542 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010543
10544
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010545option tcp-smart-accept
10546no option tcp-smart-accept
10547 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10549 yes | yes | yes | no
10550 Arguments : none
10551
10552 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10553 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10554 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10555 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10556 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10557 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10558
10559 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10560 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10561 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10562 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10563
10564 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10565 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10566 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010567 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010568
10569 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10570 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10571 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10572
10573 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10574 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10575 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10576
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010577 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10578
10579
10580option tcp-smart-connect
10581no option tcp-smart-connect
10582 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10584 yes | no | yes | yes
10585 Arguments : none
10586
10587 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10588 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10589 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10590 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10591 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10592
10593 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10594 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10595 complex.
10596
10597 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10598 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10599 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10600
10601 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10602 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10603
10604 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10605
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010606
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010607option tcpka
10608 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10610 yes | yes | yes | yes
10611 Arguments : none
10612
10613 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10614 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010615 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010616 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10617
10618 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10619 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10620 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10621 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10622
10623 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10624 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10625 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10626 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10627 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10628
10629 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10630
10631 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10632 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10633 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10634 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10635 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10636 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10637 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10638 backends.
10639
10640 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10641
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010642
10643option tcplog
10644 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010646 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010647 Arguments : none
10648
10649 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10650 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10651 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10652 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10653 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10654 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10655 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10656 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10657
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010658 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010660 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010661
10662
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010663option transparent
10664no option transparent
10665 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010667 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010668 Arguments : none
10669
10670 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10671 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10672 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10673 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10674 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10675 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10676 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10677 appropriate server.
10678
10679 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10680 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10681
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010682 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010683 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010684
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010685
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010686external-check command <command>
10687 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10689 yes | no | yes | yes
10690
10691 Arguments :
10692 <command> is the external command to run
10693
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010694 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10695
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010696 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010697
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010698 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10699 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10700 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10701 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10702 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10703 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010704
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010705 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10706
10707 Environment variables :
10708 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10709 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10710
10711 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10712
10713 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10714
10715 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10716 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10717 for a UNIX socket).
10718
10719 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10720
10721 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10722
10723 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10724
10725 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10726
10727 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10728
10729 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10730 socket).
10731
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010732 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10733
10734 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10735 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10736 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10737 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10738 TCP server).
10739
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010740 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10741 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10742
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010743 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10744
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010745 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10746 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10747 failed.
10748
10749 Example :
10750 external-check command /bin/true
10751
10752 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10753
10754
10755external-check path <path>
10756 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10758 yes | no | yes | yes
10759
10760 Arguments :
10761 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10762
10763 The default path is "".
10764
10765 Example :
10766 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10767
10768 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10769 "external-check command"
10770
10771
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010772persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010773persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010774 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10776 yes | no | yes | yes
10777 Arguments :
10778 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010779 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10780 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010781
10782 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10783 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010784 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010785 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10786 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10787 forwarded to this server.
10788
10789 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10790 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10791 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010792 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010793 a single "listen" section.
10794
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010795 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10796 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10797 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10798
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010799 Example :
10800 listen tse-farm
10801 bind :3389
10802 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10803 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10804 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10805 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10806 persist rdp-cookie
10807 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010808 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010809 balance rdp-cookie
10810 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10811 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10812
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010813 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010814
10815
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010816rate-limit sessions <rate>
10817 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10819 yes | yes | yes | no
10820 Arguments :
10821 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10822 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10823
10824 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10825 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10826 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010827 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010828 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10829 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10830
10831 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10832 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10833 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10834 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10835
10836 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10837 listen smtp
10838 mode tcp
10839 bind :25
10840 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010841 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010842
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010843 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10844 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10845 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010846
10847 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10848
10849
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010850redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10851redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10852redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010853 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10855 no | yes | yes | yes
10856
10857 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010858 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010859
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010860 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010861 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010862 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10863 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10864 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010865
10866 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10867 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10868 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10869 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10870 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010871 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10872 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10873 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10874 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010875
10876 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10877 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10878 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10879 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10880 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10881 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010882 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010883 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010884 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10885 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10886 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010887
10888 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010889 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10890 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10891 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010892 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010893 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10894 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10895 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10896 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010897
10898 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010899 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010900
10901 - "drop-query"
10902 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10903 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10904 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10905 with a location-type redirect.
10906
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010907 - "append-slash"
10908 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10909 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10910 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10911 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10912
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010913 - "ignore-empty"
10914 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10915 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10916 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10917 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10918 of known paths using a simple map.
10919
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010920 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10921 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10922 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10923 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10924 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10925 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10926 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10927
10928 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10929 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10930 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10931 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10932 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10933 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10934 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010935
10936 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10937 acl clear dst_port 80
10938 acl secure dst_port 8080
10939 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010940 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010941 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010942 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10943
10944 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010945 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10946 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10947 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010948 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010949
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010950 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10951 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10952 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10953
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010954 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010955 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010956
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010957 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010958 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10959 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10960 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010961
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010962 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10963 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10964 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010966 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010967
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010968
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010969retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010970 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10972 yes | no | yes | yes
10973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010974 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10975 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010976
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010977 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10978 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10979 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10980 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10981 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010982
10983 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010984 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010985 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010986
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010987 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10988 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10989 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010990
10991 See also : "option redispatch"
10992
10993
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010994retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010995 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10996 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10997 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10999 yes | no | yes | yes
11000 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011001 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11002 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11003 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11004 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11005 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011006
11007 none never retry
11008
11009 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11010 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11011
11012 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11013 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11014 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11015 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11016 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11017 processing the request.
11018
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011019 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11020 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11021 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11022 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11023 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11024 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11025 overflow attack for example).
11026
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011027 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11028 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11029 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11030 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11031 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11032 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11033 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11034 amplify denial of service attacks.
11035
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011036 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11037 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11038 considered to be safe to retry.
11039
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011040 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11041 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11042 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11043 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11044 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011045
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011046 all-retryable-errors
11047 retry request for any error that are considered
11048 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11049 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11050 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
11051
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011052 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11053 not cumulative.
11054
11055 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11056 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11057 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11058 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11059
11060 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11061 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11062 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11063 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11064 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11065 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11066 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11067 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11068 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11069 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11070 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11071 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11072
11073 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11074 should not use this directive.
11075
11076 The default is "conn-failure".
11077
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011078 Example:
11079 retry-on 503 504
11080
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011081 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11082
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011083server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011084 Declare a server in a backend
11085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11086 no | no | yes | yes
11087 Arguments :
11088 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011089 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011090 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011091
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011092 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11093 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11094 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11095 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011096 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11097 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011098 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011099 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11100 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011101 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11102 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11103 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11104 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11105 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11106 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11107 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011108 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011109 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11110 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11111 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11112 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11113 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11114 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011115 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11116 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011117 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11118 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011120 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011121 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11122 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11123 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11124 adding this value to the client's port.
11125
11126 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11127 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011128 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011129
11130 Examples :
11131 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11132 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011133 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011134 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11135 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11136 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011137
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011138 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11139 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11140 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11141 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11142 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11143
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011144 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11145 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011146
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011147server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011148 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011149 this backend.
11150 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11151 no | no | yes | yes
11152
11153 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11154 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11155 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11156 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11157 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011158
11159 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11160 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11161
11162 global
11163 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11164
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011165 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011166 load-server-state-from-file
11167
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011168 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011169 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011170
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011171server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11172 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11173 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11175 no | no | yes | yes
11176
11177 Arguments:
11178 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11179
11180 <num | range>
11181 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11182 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11183 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11184 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11185
11186 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11187
11188 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11189
11190 <params*>
11191 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11192 keyword.
11193
11194 Examples:
11195 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11196 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11197 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11198
11199 # or
11200 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11201
11202 # would be equivalent to:
11203 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11204 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11205 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11206
11207
11208
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011209source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011210source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011211source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011212 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11214 yes | no | yes | yes
11215 Arguments :
11216 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11217 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011218
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011219 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011220 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11221 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11222 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11223 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11224 supported prefixes are :
11225 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11226 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11227 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011228 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011229 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11230 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011231
11232 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11233 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011234 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11235 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11236 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011237
11238 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11239 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11240 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11241 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11242 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11243 <addr>.
11244
11245 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11246 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11247 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11248 port.
11249
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011250 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11251 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11252 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11253 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011254 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011255 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11256 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11257 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11258 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11259 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11260 HTTP header.
11261
11262 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11263 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011264 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011265 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11266 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11267 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11268 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11269 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11270 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11271 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11272
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011273 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11274 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11275 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11276 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11277 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11278 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11279
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011280 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11281 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11282 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11283 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11284
11285 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11286 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11287 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11288 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11289 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11290 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11291
11292 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11293 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11294 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11295 there are two methods :
11296
11297 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11298 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11299 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11300 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11301 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11302 of the client ranges may be used.
11303
11304 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11305 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11306 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11307 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11308 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11309 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11310 same session.
11311
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011312 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11313 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11314 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011315 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011316
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011317 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
11318
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011319 Examples :
11320 backend private
11321 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11322 source 192.168.1.200
11323
11324 backend transparent_ssl1
11325 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11326 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11327
11328 backend transparent_ssl2
11329 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11330 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11331 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11332
11333 backend transparent_ssl3
11334 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11335 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11336 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11337
11338 backend transparent_smtp
11339 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11340 # with Tproxy version 4.
11341 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11342
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011343 backend transparent_http
11344 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11345 # proxy.
11346 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011348 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011349 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11350
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011351
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011352srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11353 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11354 the connection on the server side.
11355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11356 yes | no | yes | yes
11357 Arguments :
11358 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11359
11360 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11361 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011362 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11363 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011364
11365 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11366
11367
11368srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11369 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11370 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11371 server side.
11372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11373 yes | no | yes | yes
11374 Arguments :
11375 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11376 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11377 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11378 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11379
11380 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11381 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011382 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11383 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011384
11385 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11386
11387
11388srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11389 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11391 yes | no | yes | yes
11392 Arguments :
11393 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11394 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11395 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11396 document.
11397
11398 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11399 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011400 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11401 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011402
11403 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11404
11405
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011406stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11407 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011409 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011410
11411 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11412 matched.
11413
11414 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11415 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11416
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011417 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11418 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11419 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11420 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011421
11422 Example :
11423 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11424 backend stats_localhost
11425 stats enable
11426 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11427
11428 Example :
11429 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11430 backend stats_auth
11431 stats enable
11432 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11433 stats admin if TRUE
11434
11435 Example :
11436 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11437 userlist stats-auth
11438 group admin users admin
11439 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11440 group readonly users haproxy
11441 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11442
11443 backend stats_auth
11444 stats enable
11445 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11446 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11447 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11448 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11449
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011450 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11451 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011452
11453
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011454stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11455 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011457 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011458 Arguments :
11459 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11460
11461 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11462
11463 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11464 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11465 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11466 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11467 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11468 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11469
11470 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11471 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11472 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011473 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011474
11475 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11476 report using "stats scope".
11477
11478 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11479 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11480 unobvious parameters.
11481
11482 Example :
11483 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11484 backend public_www
11485 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11486 stats enable
11487 stats hide-version
11488 stats scope .
11489 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011490 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011491 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11492 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11493
11494 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11495 backend private_monitoring
11496 stats enable
11497 stats uri /admin?stats
11498 stats refresh 5s
11499
11500 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11501
11502
11503stats enable
11504 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011506 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011507 Arguments : none
11508
11509 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11510 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11511 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11512 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11513 - stats auth : no authentication
11514 - stats scope : no restriction
11515
11516 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11517 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11518 unobvious parameters.
11519
11520 Example :
11521 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11522 backend public_www
11523 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11524 stats enable
11525 stats hide-version
11526 stats scope .
11527 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011528 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011529 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11530 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11531
11532 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11533 backend private_monitoring
11534 stats enable
11535 stats uri /admin?stats
11536 stats refresh 5s
11537
11538 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11539
11540
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011541stats hide-version
11542 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011544 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011545 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011546
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011547 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11548 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11549 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11550 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11551 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11552 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011554 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11555 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11556 unobvious parameters.
11557
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011558 Example :
11559 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11560 backend public_www
11561 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011562 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011563 stats hide-version
11564 stats scope .
11565 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011566 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011567 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11568 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011569
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011570 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11571 backend private_monitoring
11572 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011573 stats uri /admin?stats
11574 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011575
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011576 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011577
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011578
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011579stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11581 Access control for statistics
11582
11583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11584 no | no | yes | yes
11585
11586 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11587 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11588 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11589 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11590 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11591 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11592
11593 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11594 instance.
11595
11596 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11597 about ACL usage.
11598
11599
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011600stats realm <realm>
11601 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011603 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011604 Arguments :
11605 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11606 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11607 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11608
11609 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11610 using a backslash ('\').
11611
11612 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11613 only related to authentication.
11614
11615 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11616 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11617 unobvious parameters.
11618
11619 Example :
11620 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11621 backend public_www
11622 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11623 stats enable
11624 stats hide-version
11625 stats scope .
11626 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011627 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011628 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11629 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11630
11631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11632 backend private_monitoring
11633 stats enable
11634 stats uri /admin?stats
11635 stats refresh 5s
11636
11637 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11638
11639
11640stats refresh <delay>
11641 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011643 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011644 Arguments :
11645 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11646 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11647 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11648 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11649 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11650 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11651
11652 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11653 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11654 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011655 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011656
11657 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11658 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11659 unobvious parameters.
11660
11661 Example :
11662 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11663 backend public_www
11664 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11665 stats enable
11666 stats hide-version
11667 stats scope .
11668 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011669 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011670 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11671 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11672
11673 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11674 backend private_monitoring
11675 stats enable
11676 stats uri /admin?stats
11677 stats refresh 5s
11678
11679 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11680
11681
11682stats scope { <name> | "." }
11683 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011685 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011686 Arguments :
11687 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11688 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11689 section in which the statement appears.
11690
11691 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11692 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11693 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11694 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11695 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11696 exists.
11697
11698 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11699 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11700 unobvious parameters.
11701
11702 Example :
11703 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11704 backend public_www
11705 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11706 stats enable
11707 stats hide-version
11708 stats scope .
11709 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011710 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011711 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11712 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11713
11714 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11715 backend private_monitoring
11716 stats enable
11717 stats uri /admin?stats
11718 stats refresh 5s
11719
11720 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11721
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011722
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011723stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011724 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011726 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011727
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011728 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011729 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11730
11731 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11732 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11733
11734 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11735 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011736 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011737
11738 Example :
11739 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11740 backend private_monitoring
11741 stats enable
11742 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11743 stats uri /admin?stats
11744 stats refresh 5s
11745
11746 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11747 global section.
11748
11749
11750stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011751 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11753 yes | yes | yes | yes
11754 Arguments : none
11755
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011756 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011757 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11758 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11759 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11760 - IP (socket, server)
11761 - cookie (backend, server)
11762
11763 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11764 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011765 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011766
11767 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11768
11769
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011770stats show-modules
11771 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11773 yes | yes | yes | yes
11774 Arguments : none
11775
11776 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11777 values as a tooltip.
11778
11779 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11780 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11781 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11782
11783 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11784
11785
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011786stats show-node [ <name> ]
11787 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011789 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011790 Arguments:
11791 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11792 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11793
11794 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11795 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011796 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011797
11798 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11799 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11800 unobvious parameters.
11801
11802 Example:
11803 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11804 backend private_monitoring
11805 stats enable
11806 stats show-node Europe-1
11807 stats uri /admin?stats
11808 stats refresh 5s
11809
11810 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11811 section.
11812
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011813
11814stats uri <prefix>
11815 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011818 Arguments :
11819 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11820 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11821 query string.
11822
11823 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11824 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11825 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11826 possible to reach it in the application.
11827
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011828 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011829 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011830 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11831 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11832 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11833 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11834
11835 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11836 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11837 an address or a port to statistics only.
11838
11839 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11840 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11841 unobvious parameters.
11842
11843 Example :
11844 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11845 backend public_www
11846 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11847 stats enable
11848 stats hide-version
11849 stats scope .
11850 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011851 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011852 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11853 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11854
11855 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11856 backend private_monitoring
11857 stats enable
11858 stats uri /admin?stats
11859 stats refresh 5s
11860
11861 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11862
11863
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011864stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11865 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011867 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011868
11869 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011870 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011871 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011872 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011873 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11874
11875 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11876 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11877 the "stick-table" statement.
11878
11879 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11880 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11881 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11882 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11883 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11884
11885 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11886 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11887 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11888 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11889 transformation rules.
11890
11891 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11892 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11893 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11894 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11895 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11896 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11897 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11898
11899 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11900 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11901 ACL based conditions.
11902
11903 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11904 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11905 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11906 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11907
11908 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11909 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11910 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11911 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11912
11913 Example :
11914 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11915 # last 30 minutes
11916 backend pop
11917 mode tcp
11918 balance roundrobin
11919 stick store-request src
11920 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11921 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11922 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11923
11924 backend smtp
11925 mode tcp
11926 balance roundrobin
11927 stick match src table pop
11928 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11929 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11930
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011931 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11932 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011933
11934
11935stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11936 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11938 no | no | yes | yes
11939
11940 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11941 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11942 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11943 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11944
11945 Examples :
11946 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011947 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011948
11949 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11950 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11951 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11952
11953
11954 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11955 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11956 backend http
11957 mode http
11958 balance roundrobin
11959 stick on src table https
11960 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11961 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11962 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11963
11964 backend https
11965 mode tcp
11966 balance roundrobin
11967 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11968 stick on src
11969 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11970 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11971
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011972 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011973
11974
11975stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11976 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11978 no | no | yes | yes
11979
11980 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011981 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011982 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011983 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011984 server is selected.
11985
11986 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11987 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11988 the "stick-table" statement.
11989
11990 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11991 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11992 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11993 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11994 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11995 address.
11996
11997 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11998 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11999 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12000 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12001 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12002 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12003 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12004 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12005 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12006 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12007
12008 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12009 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12010 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12011 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12012 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12013 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12014 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12015
12016 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12017 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12018 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12019 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12020
12021 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12022 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12023 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12024 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12025 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12026 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012027 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12028 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12029 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12030 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12031 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12032 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012033
12034 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12035 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12036 the request.
12037
12038 Example :
12039 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12040 # last 30 minutes
12041 backend pop
12042 mode tcp
12043 balance roundrobin
12044 stick store-request src
12045 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12046 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12047 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12048
12049 backend smtp
12050 mode tcp
12051 balance roundrobin
12052 stick match src table pop
12053 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12054 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12055
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012056 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012057
12058
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012059stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012060 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012061 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012062 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012064 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012065
12066 Arguments :
12067 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12068 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12069 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12070 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12071
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012072 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12073 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12074 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12075 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12076
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012077 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12078 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12079 instance.
12080
12081 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12082 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12083 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12084 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12085 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12086 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012087 to 32 characters.
12088
12089 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12090 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12091 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012092 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012093 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12094 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012095
12096 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012097 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12098 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012099 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12100 increase.
12101
12102 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012103 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12104 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12105 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012106
12107 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012108 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012109 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12110 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012111 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012112 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12113 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12114 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12115 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12116 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12117 parameter (see below).
12118
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012119 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12120 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12121 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12122 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12123 soft restart.
12124
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012125 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012126 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12127 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012128 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12129 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012130 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012131 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012132 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12133 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012134 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12135 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012136
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012137 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12138 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12139 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12140 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12141 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12142 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12143 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12144 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12145 token.
12146
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012147 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12148 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12149 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12150 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012151 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12152 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12153 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12154 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12155 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12156 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12157 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12158 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12159 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12160 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12161 types and their arguments.
12162
12163 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12164 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12165 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12166 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12167
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012168 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12169 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12170 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12171 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12172 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12173 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12174 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12175 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12176 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12177 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012178 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12179 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12180 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12181 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012182
12183 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12184 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12185 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12186 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12187 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12188 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012189 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12190 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12191 update message can fit into the buffer.
12192 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12193 store only the counter gpc0.
12194 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012195 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12196 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12197 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012198 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12199 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12200 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12201 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012202
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012203 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12204 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12205 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012206 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012207
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012208 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12209 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12210 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012211 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012212 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012213 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012214
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012215 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12216 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12217 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12218 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12219
12220 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12221 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12222 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12223 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12224 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12225 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12226
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012227 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12228 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12229 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12230 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12231 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012232 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12233 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12234 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12235 to store only the tag gpt0.
12236 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12237 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12238 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012239 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12240 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12241 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012242
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012243 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12244 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12245 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12246 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12247
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012248 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12249 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12250 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12251 they were received.
12252
12253 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12254 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12255 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12256 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12257 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12258
12259 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12260 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12261 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12262 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12263 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12264
12265 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12266 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12267 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12268
12269 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12270 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12271 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12272 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12273 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12274
12275 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12276 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12277 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12278 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12279 the client side.
12280
12281 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12282 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12283 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12284 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12285 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12286 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12287 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12288
12289 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12290 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12291 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12292 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12293 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12294 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012295 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012296
12297 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12298 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12299 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12300 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12301 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12302 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12303
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012304 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12305 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12306 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12307 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12308 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12309
12310 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12311 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12312 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12313 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12314 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12315 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12316
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012317 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012318 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012319 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12320 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12321
12322 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12323 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12324 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12325 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12326 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12327 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12328 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12329 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12330 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12331 recommended for better fairness.
12332
12333 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012334 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012335 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12336 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12337
12338 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12339 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12340 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12341 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12342 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12343 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12344 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12345 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12346 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12347 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012348
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012349 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12350 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012351 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12352 reference it.
12353
12354 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12355 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012356 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12357 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12358 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012359
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012360 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12361 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12362 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12363 something that can be ignored.
12364
12365 Example:
12366 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12367 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12368 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12369 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12370
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012371 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012372 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012373
12374
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012375stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012376 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12378 no | no | yes | yes
12379
12380 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012381 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012382 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012383 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012384 server is selected.
12385
12386 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12387 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12388 the "stick-table" statement.
12389
12390 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12391 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12392 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12393 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12394
12395 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12396 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12397 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12398 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12399 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12400 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012401 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012402 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12403 rules.
12404
12405 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12406 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12407 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12408 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12409 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12410 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12411 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12412
12413 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12414 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12415 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12416 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12417
12418 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12419 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12420 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12421 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12422 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12423 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012424 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12425 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12426 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12427 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12428 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12429 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12430 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12431 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12432 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012433
12434 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12435
12436 Example :
12437 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12438 backend https
12439 mode tcp
12440 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012441 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012442 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012443
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012444 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12445 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012446
12447 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12448 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12449 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12450
12451 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12452 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012453
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012454 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12455 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12456 # at offset 44.
12457
12458 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012459 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012460
12461 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012462 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012463
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012464 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12465 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12466
12467 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12468 extraction.
12469
12470
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012471tcp-check comment <string>
12472 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12473 it fails.
12474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12475 yes | no | yes | yes
12476
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012477 Arguments :
12478 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12479 rule fails.
12480
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012481 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12482 user-friendly error reporting.
12483
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012484 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12485 "tcp-check expect".
12486
12487
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012488tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12489 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012490 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012491 Opens a new connection
12492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012493 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012495 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012496 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12497
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012498 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012499 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012500
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012501 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012502 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12503 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012504 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012505
12506 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012507
12508 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12509
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012510 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12511
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012512 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12513
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012514 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12515
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012516 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12517 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12518 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12519 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12520
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012521 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12522 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12523 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12524 haproxy -vv.
12525
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012526 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012528 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12529 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12530 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12531
12532 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12533 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12534 of the sequence.
12535
12536 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12537 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12538 do.
12539
12540 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12541 unset-var or comment rules.
12542
12543 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012544 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12545 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12546 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12547 option tcp-check
12548 tcp-check connect
12549 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12550 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12551 tcp-check send \r\n
12552 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12553 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12554 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12555 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12556 tcp-check send \r\n
12557 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12558 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12559
12560 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12561 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012562 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012563 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12564 tcp-check connect port 143
12565 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12566 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12567
12568 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12569
12570
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012571tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012572 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012573 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012574 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012575 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012577 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012578
12579 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012580 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12581
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012582 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12583 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12584 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12585 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12586 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12587 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12588 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12589 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12590 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12591 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12592
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012593 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012594 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12595 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012596 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12597 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12598 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12599
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012600 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12601 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12602 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012603 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12604 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012605 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12606 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012607 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12608 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012609 By default "L7OK" is used.
12610
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012611 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12612 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012613 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12614 supported :
12615 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12616 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012617 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12618 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12619 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12620 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12621 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012622
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012623 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012624 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012625 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12626 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12627 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12628 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012629 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12630
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012631 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12632 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12633 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12634 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12635
12636 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12637 informational message reported in logs if an error
12638 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12639 log-format string.
12640
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012641 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12642 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12643 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12644 followed by some converters.
12645
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012646 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12647 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12648 with the usual backslash ('\').
12649 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012650 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012651 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12652 used upper or lower case.
12653
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012654 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12655
12656 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12657 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12658 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12659 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12660 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12661 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12662 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12663 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12664
12665 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12666 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12667 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12668 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12669 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12670 expression.
12671
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012672 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12673 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12674 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12675 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12676 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12677 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12678
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012679 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12680 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12681 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12682 this exact hexadecimal string.
12683 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12684
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012685 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12686 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12687 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12688 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12689 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12690 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12691 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12692 size.
12693
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012694 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12695 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12696 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12697 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12698 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12699 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12700 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12701 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12702 in a binary string before matching the response's
12703 buffer.
12704
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012705 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012706 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012707 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12708 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12709 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12710 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12711 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12712 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12713 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12714 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12715 the null character.
12716
12717 Examples :
12718 # perform a POP check
12719 option tcp-check
12720 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12721
12722 # perform an IMAP check
12723 option tcp-check
12724 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12725
12726 # look for the redis master server
12727 option tcp-check
12728 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012729 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012730 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12731 tcp-check expect string role:master
12732 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12733 tcp-check expect string +OK
12734
12735
12736 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012737 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012738
12739
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012740tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12741tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12742 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12743 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012745 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012746
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012747 Arguments :
12748 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12749
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012750 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12751 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012752
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012753 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12754 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012755
12756 Examples :
12757 # look for the redis master server
12758 option tcp-check
12759 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12760 tcp-check expect string role:master
12761
12762 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012763 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012764
12765
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012766tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12767tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12768 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12769 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012770 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012771 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012772
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012773 Arguments :
12774 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012775
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012776 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12777 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012778
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012779 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12780 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12781 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012782
12783 Examples :
12784 # redis check in binary
12785 option tcp-check
12786 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12787 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12788
12789
12790 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012791 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012792
12793
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012794tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12795tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012796 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012797 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012798 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012799
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012800 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012801 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12802 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12803 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12804 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12805 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12806 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12807 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12808 and '-'.
12809
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012810 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12811 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012812 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012813 conditions.
12814
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012815 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12816
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012817 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12818 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12819
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012820 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012821 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012822 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012823
12824
12825tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012826 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012828 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012829
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012830 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012831 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12832 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12833 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12834 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12835 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12836 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12837 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12838 and '-'.
12839
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012840 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012841 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12842
12843
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012844tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012845 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012847 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012848 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012849 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12850 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012851
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012852 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012853
12854 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12855 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012856 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12857 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12858 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12859 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12860 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12861 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012862
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012863 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12864 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12865 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012866 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12867 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12868 is true.
12869
12870 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12871 supported:
12872 - accept
12873 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12874 - expect-proxy layer4
12875 - reject
12876 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12877 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12878 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12879 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12880 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12881 - set-dst <expr>
12882 - set-dst-port <expr>
12883 - set-mark <mark>
12884 - set-src <expr>
12885 - set-src-port <expr>
12886 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012887 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12888 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010012889 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012890 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12891 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12892 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012893 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012894
12895 The supported actions are described below.
12896
12897 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12898 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012899
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012900 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12901 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12902 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12903 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12904 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12905 a defaults section defining such rules.
12906
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012907 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12908 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12909 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012910
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012911 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12912 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12913 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012914
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012915 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12916 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12917 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012918
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012919 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12920 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12921 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012922
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012923 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12924 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12925 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012926
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012927 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012928
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012929 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012930
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012931 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012932
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012933 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012934
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012935tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012936
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012937 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12938 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012939
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012940tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12941 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012942
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012943 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12944 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12945 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12946 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12947 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12948 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12949 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012950
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012951tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012952
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012953 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12954 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12955 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12956 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12957 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12958 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012959
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012960tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012961
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012962 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12963 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12964 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12965 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12966 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12967 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12968 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12969 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12970 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12971 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12972 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012973
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012974tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12975tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12976tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012977
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012978 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12979 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12980 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12981 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012982
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012983tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12984 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12985tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12986 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012987
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012988 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12989 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12990 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012991
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012992tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12993tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012994
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012995 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12996 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12997 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012998
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012999tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013000
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013001 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13002 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13003 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013004
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013005tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13006tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013007
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013008 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13009 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13010 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013011
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013012tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013013
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013014 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13015 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13016 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013017
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013018tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13019tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013020
13021 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13022 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13023 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13024 for a complete description.
13025
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013026tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013027
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013028 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13029 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13030 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13031 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013032
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013033tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13034tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13035tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013036
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013037 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13038 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13039 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013040
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013041tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13042
13043 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13044 details about variables.
13045
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013047tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13048 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013050 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013051 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013052 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13053 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013055 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013056
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013057 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013058 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13059 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013060 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13061 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013063 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13064 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13065 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13066 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013067 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013068 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013069 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13070 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13071 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13072 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013073 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013074 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013076 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13077 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13078 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13079 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013080
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013081 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13082 supported:
13083 - accept
13084 - capture <sample> len <length>
13085 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13086 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013087 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013088 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013089 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013090 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013091 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013092 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013093 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013094 - set-dst <expr>
13095 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013096 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013097 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013098 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013099 - set-priority-class <expr>
13100 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013101 - set-src <expr>
13102 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013103 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013104 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13105 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013106 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013107 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013108 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13109 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13110 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013111 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013112 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013113
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013114 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013115
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013116 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13117 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13118 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13119 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13120 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13121 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013122
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013123 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13124 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13125 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13126 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13127 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13128 a defaults section defining such rules.
13129
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013130 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013131 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13132 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013133
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013134 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13135 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13136 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13137 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13138 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13139 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013141 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013142 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13143 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13144 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13145 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13146 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13147 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13148 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13149 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13150 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13151 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013152
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013153 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013154 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13155 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13156 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013157
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013158 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013159 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013160
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013161 Example:
13162
13163 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013164 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013165 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013166
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013167 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013168 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013169 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013170 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13171 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013172 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013173 tcp-request content reject
13174
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013175 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13176 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13177 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13178 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13179 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13180 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13181 ...
13182 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13183
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013184 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013185 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13186 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013187 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013188 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013189
13190 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13191 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013192 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013193 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013194 tcp-request content reject
13195
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013196 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013197 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013198 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013199 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013200 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13201 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013202
13203 Example:
13204 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13205 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013206 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013207
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013208 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013209 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013210
13211 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013212 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013213 # protecting all our sites
13214 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013215 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13216 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013217 ...
13218 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13219
13220 backend http_dynamic
13221 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013222 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013223 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013224 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013225 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013226 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013227 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013229 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013230
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013231 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13232 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013233
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013234tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13235
13236 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013237 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013238
13239tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13241
13242 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13243 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13244 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13245 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13246 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13247 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13248 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13249 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13250 information.
13251
13252tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13253
13254 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13255 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13256 complete description.
13257
13258tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13259
13260 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13261 are evaluated.
13262
13263tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13264tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13265tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13266
13267 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13268 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13269 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13270 description.
13271
13272tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13273 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13274tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13275 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13276
13277 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13278 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13279 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
13280
13281tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13282 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13283
13284 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13285 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13286
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013287tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13288 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013289
13290 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13291 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13292 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13293
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013294tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13295tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13296
13297 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13298 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13299 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13300
13301tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13302
13303 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13304 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13305
13306tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13307
13308 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13309 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13310 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13311
13312tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13313
13314 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13315 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13316
13317tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13318
13319 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13320 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13321
13322tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13323
13324 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13325 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13326 description.
13327
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013328tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13329tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13330
13331 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13332 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13333 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13334
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013335tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13336
13337 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13338 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13339 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13340
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013341tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13342tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013343
13344 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13345 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13346 for a complete description.
13347
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013348tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013349
13350 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13351 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13352 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13353 complete description.
13354
13355tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13356 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13357
13358 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13359 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13360 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13361 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13362 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13363 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13364 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13365 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13366 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13367 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13368
13369 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13370
13371tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13372tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13373tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13374
13375 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13376 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13377 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13378
13379tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13380
13381 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13382 details about variables.
13383
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013384tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013385
13386 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13387 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13388 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13389 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13390 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13391
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013392
13393tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13394 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013396 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013397 Arguments :
13398 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13399 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13400 as explained at the top of this document.
13401
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013402 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013403 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13404 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13405 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13406 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13407
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013408 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13409 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13410 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13411 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13412
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013413 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013414 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013415 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013416 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013417 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013418 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13419 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13420 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013421
13422 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13423 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13424 it pass through unaffected.
13425
13426 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13427 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13428 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013429 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013430 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13431 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013432 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13433 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13434 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013435
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013436 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13437 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13438
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013439 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013440 "timeout client".
13441
13442
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013443tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13444 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013446 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013447 Arguments :
13448 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13449 below.
13450
13451 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13452
13453 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13454 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13455 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13456 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013457 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013458 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13459 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13460 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13461 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13462 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13463 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13464 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13465 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13466 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13467 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13468 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13469 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13470 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13471 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13472 instead.
13473
13474 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13475 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13476 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13477 rules which may be inserted.
13478
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013479 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13480 supported:
13481 - accept
13482 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013483 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13484 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13485 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13486 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13487 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013488 - set-dst <expr>
13489 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013490 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013491 - set-src <expr>
13492 - set-src-port <expr>
13493 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013494 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13495 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013496 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013497 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13498 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13499 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13500 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013501
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013502 The supported actions are described below.
13503
13504 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13505 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13506 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13507 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13508 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13509 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013510
13511 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13512 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13513 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13514
13515 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13516 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13517 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13518 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13519 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13520
13521 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13522 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13523
13524 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13525 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13526 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13527
13528 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13529 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13530 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13531
13532 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13533 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13534 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13535
13536 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13537 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13538 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13539
13540 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13541
13542 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13543
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013544tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13545
13546 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13547 rules are evaluated.
13548
13549tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13550
13551 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13552 are evaluated.
13553
13554tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13555tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13556tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13557
13558 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13559 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13560 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13561 description.
13562
13563tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13564 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13565tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13566 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13567
13568 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13569 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13570 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13571 description.
13572
13573tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13574tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13575
13576 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13577 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13578 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13579
13580tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13581
13582 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13583 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13584 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13585
13586tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13587tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13588
13589 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13590 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13591 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13592
13593tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13594
13595 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13596 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13597 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13598
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013599tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13600tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013601
13602 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13603 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13604 for a complete description.
13605
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013606tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013607
13608 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13609 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13610 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13611 complete description.
13612
13613tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13614tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13615tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13616
13617 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13618 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13619 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13620
13621tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13622
13623 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13624 details about variables.
13625
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013626
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013627tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13628 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013630 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013631 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013632 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13633 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013634
13635 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13636
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013638 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13639 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013640 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13641 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013642
13643 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13644
13645 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13646 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13647 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13648 inserted.
13649
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013650 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13651 supported:
13652 - accept
13653 - close
13654 - reject
13655 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13656 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13657 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13658 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13659 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13660 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013661 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013662 - set-log-level <level>
13663 - set-mark <mark>
13664 - set-nice <nice>
13665 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013666 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13667 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013668 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013669 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13670
13671 The supported actions are described below.
13672
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013673 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13674 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13675 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13676 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13677 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13678 a defaults section defining such rules.
13679
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013680 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13681 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13682 for changing the default action to a reject.
13683
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013684 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013685
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013686 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13687 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13688 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13689 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13690 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013691
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013692 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013693
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013694 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013695
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013696tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013697
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013698 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13699 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013700
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013701tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013702
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013703 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13704 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13705 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13706 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13707 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13708 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013709
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013710tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013711
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013712 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13713 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013714
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013715tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13716tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13717tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013718
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013719 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13720 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13721 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13722 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013723
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013724tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13725 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13726tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13727 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013728
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013729 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13730 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13731 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013732
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013733tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13734 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013735
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013736 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13737 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013738
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013739
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013740tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13741 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013742
13743 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13744 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13745 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13746
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013747tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013748
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013749 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13750 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013751
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013752tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013753
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013754 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13755 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13756 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013757
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013758tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013759
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013760 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13761 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013762
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013763tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013764
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013765 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13766 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13767 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013768
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013769tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13770tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013771
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013772 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13773 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13774 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013775
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013776tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013777
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013778 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13779 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13780 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13781 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013782
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013783tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013784
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013785 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13786 details about variables.
13787
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013788
13789tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13790 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013792 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013793 Arguments :
13794 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13795 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13796 as explained at the top of this document.
13797
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013798 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13799 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013800
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013801 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13802
13803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013804timeout check <timeout>
13805 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13806 established.
13807
13808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13809 yes | no | yes | yes
13810 Arguments:
13811 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13812 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13813 as explained at the top of this document.
13814
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013815 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013816 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013817 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013818 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013819 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13820 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13821 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013822
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013823 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013824 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13825
13826 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13827 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013828 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013829
13830 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13831 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13832 forget about it.
13833
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013834 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13835 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13836
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013837 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13838 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013839
13840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013841timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013842 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13844 yes | yes | yes | no
13845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013846 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013847 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13848 as explained at the top of this document.
13849
13850 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13851 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13852 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013853 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13854 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13855 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13856 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013857 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13858 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13859 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013860 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013861 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013862 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13863 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013864 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13865 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013866
13867 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13868 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13869 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13870 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013871 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013872 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13873
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013874 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013876
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013877timeout client-fin <timeout>
13878 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13880 yes | yes | yes | no
13881 Arguments :
13882 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13883 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13884 as explained at the top of this document.
13885
13886 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13887 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13888 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13889 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13890 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13891 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13892 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013893 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13894 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13895 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013896
13897 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13898 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13899 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13900
13901 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13902
13903
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013904timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013905 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13907 yes | no | yes | yes
13908 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013909 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013910 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13911 as explained at the top of this document.
13912
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013913 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013914 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013915 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013916 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013917 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13918 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013919
13920 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13921 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13922 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13923 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013924 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013925 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13926
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013927 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013929
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013930timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13931 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13933 yes | yes | yes | yes
13934 Arguments :
13935 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13936 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13937 as explained at the top of this document.
13938
13939 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13940 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13941 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13942 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13943 once the request has started to present itself.
13944
13945 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13946 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13947 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13948 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13949 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13950
13951 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13952 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13953 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13954 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13955
13956 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13957 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013958 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013959 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13960 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013961 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013962
13963 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13964 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13965 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13966 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13967
13968 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13969
13970
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013971timeout http-request <timeout>
13972 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013974 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013975 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013976 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013977 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13978 as explained at the top of this document.
13979
13980 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13981 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13982 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13983 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13984 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13985 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13986 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013987 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13988 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13989 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13990 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013991 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013992 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13993 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013994
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013995 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13996 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13997 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13998 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13999 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014000 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014001
14002 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14003 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014004 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014005 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14006 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14007
14008 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014009 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14010 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14011 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014012
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014013 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014014 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014015
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014016
14017timeout queue <timeout>
14018 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14020 yes | no | yes | yes
14021 Arguments :
14022 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14023 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14024 as explained at the top of this document.
14025
14026 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14027 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14028 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14029 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14030 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14031
14032 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14033 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14034 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14035 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14036
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014037 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014038
14039
14040timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014041 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14043 yes | no | yes | yes
14044 Arguments :
14045 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14046 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14047 as explained at the top of this document.
14048
14049 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14050 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14051 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14052 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14053 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14054 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14055 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14056
14057 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14058 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14059 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14060 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14061 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014062 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014063 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14065 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014066 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14067 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014068
14069 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14070 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14071 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14072 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014073 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014074 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14075
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014076 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014077
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014078
14079timeout server-fin <timeout>
14080 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14082 yes | no | yes | yes
14083 Arguments :
14084 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14085 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14086 as explained at the top of this document.
14087
14088 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14089 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14090 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14091 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14092 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14093 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14094 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14095 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14096 situations, it should not be needed.
14097
14098 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14099 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14100 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14101
14102 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14103
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014104
14105timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014106 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14108 yes | yes | yes | yes
14109 Arguments :
14110 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14111 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14112 as explained at the top of this document.
14113
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014114 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14115 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14116 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014117
14118 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14119 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14120 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14121 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014122 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014123
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014124 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014125
14126
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014127timeout tunnel <timeout>
14128 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14130 yes | no | yes | yes
14131 Arguments :
14132 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14133 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14134 as explained at the top of this document.
14135
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014136 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014137 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14138 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14139 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014140 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14141 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014142 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14143 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14144 specified.
14145
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014146 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14147 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14148 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14149 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14150 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14151 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14152 state.
14153
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014154 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14155 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14156 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14157 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014158 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014159
14160 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14161 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14162 forget about it.
14163
14164 Example :
14165 defaults http
14166 option http-server-close
14167 timeout connect 5s
14168 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014169 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014170 timeout server 30s
14171 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14172
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014173 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014174
14175
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014176transparent (deprecated)
14177 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014179 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014180 Arguments : none
14181
14182 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14183 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14184 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14185 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14186 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14187 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14188 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14189 appropriate server.
14190
14191 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14192
14193 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14194 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14195
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014196 See also: "option transparent"
14197
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014198unique-id-format <string>
14199 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14201 yes | yes | yes | no
14202 Arguments :
14203 <string> is a log-format string.
14204
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014205 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14206 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14207 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14208 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014209
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014210 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014211 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014212 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14213 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14214 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14215 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14216 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14217 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014218
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014219 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14220 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014221
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014222 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014223
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014224 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014225
14226 will generate:
14227
14228 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14229
14230 See also: "unique-id-header"
14231
14232unique-id-header <name>
14233 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14235 yes | yes | yes | no
14236 Arguments :
14237 <name> is the name of the header.
14238
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014239 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14240 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014241
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014242 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014243
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014244 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014245 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14246
14247 will generate:
14248
14249 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14250
14251 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014252
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014253use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014254 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14256 no | yes | yes | no
14257 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014258 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14259 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014260
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014261 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14262 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014263
14264 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14265 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14266 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014267 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014268 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014269 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14270 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014271
14272 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14273 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14274 assign the backend.
14275
14276 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14277 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14278 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14279 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14280 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14281 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14282
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014283 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014284 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014285 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14286 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14287 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14288
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014289 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14290 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14291 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14292 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14293 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14294 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14295 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14296 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14297 cannot be forced from the request.
14298
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014299 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014300 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14301 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14302
14303 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14304 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014305
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014306use-fcgi-app <name>
14307 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14309 no | no | yes | yes
14310 Arguments :
14311 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14312
14313 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014314
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014315use-server <server> if <condition>
14316use-server <server> unless <condition>
14317 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14319 no | no | yes | yes
14320 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014321 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14322 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014323
14324 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14325
14326 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14327 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14328 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14329
14330 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14331 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14332 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14333 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14334 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14335 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14336 matches will assign the server.
14337
14338 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14339 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14340 with the next rules until one matches.
14341
14342 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14343 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14344 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14345 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14346
14347 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14348 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14349 stripped.
14350
14351 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14352 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014353 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014354 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014355 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014356
14357 Example :
14358 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014359 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014360 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014361 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014362 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014363 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014364 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014365 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14366 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14367
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014368 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14369 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14370 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14371 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014372 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014373 and we fall back to load balancing.
14374
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014375 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014376
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014377
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100143785. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014379--------------------------
14380
14381The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14382depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14383settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14384written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14385described in this section.
14386
14387
143885.1. Bind options
14389-----------------
14390
14391The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14392as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14393no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14394parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14395while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14396provided immediately after the setting name.
14397
14398The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14399
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014400accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14401 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14402 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14403 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14404 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14405 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14406 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14407 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14408 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14409 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014410 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14411 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14412 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014413
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014414accept-proxy
14415 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014416 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14417 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014418 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14419 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14420 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14421 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014422 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014423 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14424 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014425 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14426 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014427
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014428allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014429 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014430 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014431 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014432 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14433 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014434
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014435alpn <protocols>
14436 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14437 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14438 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014439 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014440 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014441 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
14442 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14443 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
14444 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
14445 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
14446 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
14447 preference, like below :
14448
14449 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014450
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014451 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14452 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
14453
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014454backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014455 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014456 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14457
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014458curves <curves>
14459 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14460 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14461 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14462 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14463 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14464 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14465
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014466ecdhe <named curve>
14467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014468 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14469 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014470
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014471ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14473 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014474 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14475 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014476 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014477
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014478 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14479 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14480 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14481 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14482 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014483 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014484
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014485ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14487 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014488 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14489 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14490 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14491 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14492 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014493 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14494 error is ignored.
14495
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014496ca-sign-file <cafile>
14497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14498 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14499 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14500 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14501 'generate-certificates' for details.
14502
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014503ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14505 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14506 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14507 'generate-certificates' for details.
14508
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014509ca-verify-file <cafile>
14510 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14511 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14512 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14513 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14514 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14515
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014516ciphers <ciphers>
14517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14518 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014519 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014520 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014521 information and recommendations see e.g.
14522 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14523 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14524 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14525
14526ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14528 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14529 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14530 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014531 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14532 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014533
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014534crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014535 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14536 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014537 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14538 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014539
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014540crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014541 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14542 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14543 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14544 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14545 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014546 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14547 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014548
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014549 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14550 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14551
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014552 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14553 are loaded.
14554
14555 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014556 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014557 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14558 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14559 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14560 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14561 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14562 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14563 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
14564 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014565
14566 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14567 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14568 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14569 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014570 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14571 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014572
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014573 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014574
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014575 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014576 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014577 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14578 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014579 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14580 clients).
14581
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014582 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014583 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14584 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14585 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14586 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14587 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14588 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14589 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14590 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14591 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14592 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14593 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14594 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14595
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014596 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014597 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14598 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14599 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14600 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14601
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014602 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14603 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14604 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14605 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014606
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014607 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14608 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14609 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014610
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014611crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014613 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
14614 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14615 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14616 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14617 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14618 in new version of OpenSSL.
14619 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14620 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014621
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014622crt-list <file>
14623 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014624 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14625 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014626
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014627 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14628
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014629 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14630 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14631 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14632 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14633 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014634
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014635 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014636 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14637 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14638 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14639 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14640 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014641 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14642 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14643 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014644
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014645 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14646 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14647 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014648
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014649 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14650
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014651 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014652 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014653 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14654 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14655 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14656 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14657 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14658 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014659
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014660 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014661 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014662 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014663 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014664 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014665 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014666
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014667defer-accept
14668 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14669 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14670 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014671 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014672 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14673 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14674 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14675 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14676 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14677 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14678 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14679
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014680expose-fd listeners
14681 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14682 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014683 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14684 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014685 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014686
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014687force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014688 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014689 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014690 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014691 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014692
14693force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014694 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014695 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014696 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014697
14698force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014699 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014700 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014701 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014702
14703force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014704 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014705 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014706 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014707
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014708force-tlsv13
14709 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14710 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014711 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014712
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014713generate-certificates
14714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14715 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14716 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14717 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14718 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14719 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14720 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14721 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14722 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14723 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14724 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14725
14726 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14727 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014728 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014729 certificate is used many times.
14730
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014731gid <gid>
14732 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14733 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14734 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14735 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14736 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14737
14738group <group>
14739 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14740 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14741 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14742 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14743 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14744
14745id <id>
14746 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14747 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14748 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14749 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14750
14751interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014752 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14753 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14754 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14755 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14756 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14757 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014758 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14759 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14760 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14761 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14762 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14763 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014764
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014765level <level>
14766 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14767 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14768 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014769 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014770 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14771 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14772 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014773 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014774 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014775 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014776 all counters).
14777
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014778severity-output <format>
14779 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14780 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14781 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14782 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14783 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14784 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14785 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14786 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14787 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14788 rfc5424 convention.
14789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014790maxconn <maxconn>
14791 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14792 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14793 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14794 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14795 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14796 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14797 eat all memory.
14798
14799mode <mode>
14800 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14801 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14802 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14803 UNIX sockets.
14804
14805mss <maxseg>
14806 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14807 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14808 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14809 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14810 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14811 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14812 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14813 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14814 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14815 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14816 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14817
14818name <name>
14819 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14820 page.
14821
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014822namespace <name>
14823 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14824 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14825 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14826 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14827
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014828nice <nice>
14829 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14830 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14831 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14832 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14833 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14834 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14835 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14836 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14837 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14838 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14839 one for an RDP socket.
14840
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014841no-ca-names
14842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14843 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014844 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014845
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014846no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014848 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014849 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014850 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014851 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14852 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014853
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014854no-tls-tickets
14855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14856 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14857 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014858 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14859 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014860 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14861 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14862 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014863
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014864no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014866 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014867 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014868 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014869 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14870 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014871
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014872no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014874 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014875 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014876 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014877 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14878 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014879
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014880no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014882 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014883 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014884 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014885 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14886 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014887
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014888no-tlsv13
14889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14890 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14891 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14892 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014893 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14894 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014895
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014896npn <protocols>
14897 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14898 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14899 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014900 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014901 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014902 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14903 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14904 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14905 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14906 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014907
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010014908ocsp-update [ off | on ]
14909 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
14910 Its value defaults to 'off'.
14911 This option can only be used in a crt-list line so that is applies to only
14912 one certificate at a time. If a given certificate is used in multiple
14913 crt-lists with different values of the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be
14914 raised.
14915 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
14916 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
14917 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
14918 the OCSP certid to be built.
14919 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
14920 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
14921 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
14922 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
14923 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
14924 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
14925 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
14926 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
14927 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
14928 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
14929 short time after init.
14930 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
14931 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
14932 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
14933
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014934prefer-client-ciphers
14935 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14936 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14937 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014938 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14939 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14940 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014941
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014942proto <name>
14943 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14944 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14945 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014946 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14947 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14948
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014949 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14950 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14951 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014952
14953 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14954 a bind line :
14955
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014956 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014957 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14958 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14959
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014960 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014961 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014962 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014963 h2" on the bind line.
14964
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020014965quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
14966 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14967
14968 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
14969 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
14970 to those used by TCP.
14971
14972 Default value: cubic
14973
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014974quic-force-retry
14975 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14976 change without deprecation in the future.
14977
14978 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
14979 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
14980 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
14981 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
14982 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
14983 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
14984 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010014985 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
14986
14987 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
14988 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014989
14990 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
14991 information about QUIC retry.
14992
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014993shards <number> | by-thread
14994 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14995 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14996 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14997 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14998 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14999 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15000 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15001 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15002 little bit.
15003
15004 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15005 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15006 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15007 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15008 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
15009 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
15010
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015011ssl
15012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015013 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015014 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15015 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015016 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15017 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015018
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015019ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15020 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015021 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15022 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15023 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015024 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15025
15026ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015027 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15028 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15029 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15030 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015031
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015032strict-sni
15033 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15034 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
15035 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
15036 See the "crt" option for more information.
15037
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015038tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015039 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015040 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015041 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015042 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015043 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15044 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15045 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15046 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15047 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15048 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15049 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15050
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015051tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015052 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015053 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15054 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15055 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15056 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15057 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15058 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15059 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015060 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15061 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15062 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015063
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015064thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015065 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15066 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15067 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015068
15069 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15070 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015071 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15072 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15073 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15074 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15075 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15076 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15077 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15078 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015079
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015080 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15081 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015082
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015083 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15084
15085 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15086 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15087 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15088 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15089 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15090 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15091 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
15092 or absolute dependeing on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
15093 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15094 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15095 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15096 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15097
15098 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15099 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15100 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15101 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15102 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15103 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015104
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015105 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15106 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15107 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15108 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015109
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015110tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15111 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015112 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15113 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15114 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15115 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15116 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15117 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15118 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15119 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15120 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15121 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015122 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15123 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15124
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015125transparent
15126 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15127 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15128 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15129 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15130 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15131 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15132 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15133 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15134 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15135 so check for support with your vendor.
15136
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015137v4v6
15138 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15139 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15140 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15141 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015142 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015143
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015144v6only
15145 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15146 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15147 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015148 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15149 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015150
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015151uid <uid>
15152 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15153 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15154 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15155 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15156 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15157
15158user <user>
15159 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15160 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15161 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15162 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15163 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15164
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015165verify [none|optional|required]
15166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15167 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15168 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15169 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15170 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015171 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15172 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15173 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15174 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015175
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200151765.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015177------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015179The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15180which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15181arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15182settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15183after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15184Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15185address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015187 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015188 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015189
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015190Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15191keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015193The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015194
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015195addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015196 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015197 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15198 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15199 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15200 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15201 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015202
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015203agent-check
15204 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015205 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015206 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15207 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15208 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015209
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015210 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015211 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015212 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015213 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15214 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015215
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015216 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15217 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15218 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15219 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15220 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015221
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015222 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015223 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015224
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015225 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15226 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15227 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015228
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015229 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15230 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15231 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015232
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015233 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015234 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15235 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15236 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15237 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015238 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015239 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015240
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015241 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15242 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015243
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015244 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15245 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15246 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15247 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15248 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15249 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15250 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15251 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15252 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015253
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015254 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15255 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015256 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15257 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15258 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015259 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015260
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015261 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015262 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015263
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015264agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015265 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015266 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15267 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15268 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15269 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15270
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015271agent-inter <delay>
15272 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15273 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15274
15275 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15276 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15277 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15278 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15279 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15280 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15281 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15282 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15283 of backends use the same servers.
15284
15285 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15286
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015287agent-addr <addr>
15288 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15289
15290 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015291 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015292 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15293 hostname, it will be resolved.
15294
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015295agent-port <port>
15296 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15297
15298 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15299
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015300allow-0rtt
15301 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015302 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15303 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015304
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015305alpn <protocols>
15306 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15307 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15308 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015309 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015310 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15311 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15312 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15313 now obsolete NPN extension.
15314 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15315 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15316
15317 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15318
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015319 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015321backup
15322 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15323 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15324 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15325 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015326 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15327 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015328
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015329ca-file <cafile>
15330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15331 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015332 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15333 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015334 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015335
15336 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15337 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15338 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015340check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015341 This option enables health checks on a server:
15342 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15343 considered available.
15344 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15345 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15346 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15347 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15348 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015349 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15350 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015351 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15352 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15353 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15354 exchanges succeed.
15355
15356 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15357 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15358 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15359 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15360 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015361 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015362 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15363
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015364 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015365 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015366 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15367 not overridden.
15368
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015369 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15370 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15371
15372 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15373 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15374
15375 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15376 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15377 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15378 available.
15379
15380 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15381 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15382 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15383
15384 Example:
15385 # simple tcp check
15386 backend foo
15387 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15388 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15389 backend foo
15390 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15391 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15392 backend foo
15393 option tcp-check
15394 tcp-check connect
15395 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015396
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015397check-send-proxy
15398 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15399 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15400 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15401 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15402 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15403 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15404 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15405
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015406check-alpn <protocols>
15407 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15408 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15409 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15410
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015411check-proto <name>
15412 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15413 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15414 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015415 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15416 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15417
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015418 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15419 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15420 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015421
15422 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15423 directive on a server line:
15424
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015425 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015426 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15427 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15428 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15429
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015430 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015431 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15432 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15433
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015434check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015435 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015436 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15437 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015438
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015439check-ssl
15440 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15441 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15442 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15443 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015444 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015445 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15446 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015447 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015448 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15449 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015450
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015451check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015452 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015453 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15454 for normal traffic.
15455
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015456ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15458 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
15459 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015460 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
15461 information and recommendations see e.g.
15462 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15463 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15464 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015465
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015466ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15468 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
15469 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
15470 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015471 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
15472 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
15473 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015475cookie <value>
15476 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
15477 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
15478 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
15479 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
15480 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
15481 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15482 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15483
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015484crl-file <crlfile>
15485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15486 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15487 to verify server's certificate.
15488
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015489crt <cert>
15490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15491 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15492 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15493 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15494 certificate request.
15495
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020015496 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
15497 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
15498 option is set accordingly).
15499
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015500disabled
15501 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
15502 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
15503 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
15504 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
15505 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015506 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015507
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015508enabled
15509 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
15510 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
15511 default value.
15512 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
15513 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015515error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010015516 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
15517 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
15518 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015520 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015522fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015523 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
15524 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
15525 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
15526
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015527force-sslv3
15528 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15529 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015530 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015531 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015532
15533force-tlsv10
15534 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015535 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015536 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015537
15538force-tlsv11
15539 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015540 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015541 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015542
15543force-tlsv12
15544 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015545 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015546 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015547
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015548force-tlsv13
15549 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15550 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015551 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015553id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020015554 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
15555 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
15556 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015557
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015558init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
15559 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
15560 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015561 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015562 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
15563 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
15564 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
15565 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
15566 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
15567 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
15568 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
15569 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
15570 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015571 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015572 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
15573 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
15574 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
15575 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
15576 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
15577 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015578 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015579
15580 Example:
15581 defaults
15582 # never fail on address resolution
15583 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
15584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015585inter <delay>
15586fastinter <delay>
15587downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015588 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
15589 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15590 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
15591 between checks depending on the server state :
15592
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020015593 Server state | Interval used
15594 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15595 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
15596 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15597 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
15598 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
15599 or yet unchecked. |
15600 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15601 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15602 | "inter" otherwise.
15603 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015605 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15606 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15607 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15608 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015609 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15610 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15611 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15612 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15613 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015614
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015615log-proto <logproto>
15616 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15617 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15618 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15619 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015621maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015622 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15623 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015624 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15625 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015626 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15627 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15628 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15629 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15630
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015631 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15632 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15633 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15634 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15635 than 50 concurrent requests.
15636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015637maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015638 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15639 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15640 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15641 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015642 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15643 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15644 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15645 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15646 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15647 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15648 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015649
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015650max-reuse <count>
15651 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15652 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15653 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15654 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15655 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15656 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15657 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15658 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015660minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015661 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15662 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15663 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15664 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15665 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15666 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015667 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015668 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015669
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015670namespace <name>
15671 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15672 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15673 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15674 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15675
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015676no-agent-check
15677 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15678 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15679 default value.
15680 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15681 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15682
15683no-backup
15684 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15685 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15686 default value.
15687 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15688 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15689
15690no-check
15691 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15692 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15693 default value.
15694 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15695 "default-server" "check" setting.
15696
15697no-check-ssl
15698 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15699 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15700 default value.
15701 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15702 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15703
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015704no-send-proxy
15705 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15706 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15707 default value.
15708 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15709 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15710
15711no-send-proxy-v2
15712 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15713 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15714 default value.
15715 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15716 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15717
15718no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15719 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15720 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15721 default value.
15722 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15723 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15724
15725no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15726 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15727 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15728 default value.
15729 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15730 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15731
15732no-ssl
15733 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15734 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15735 default value.
15736 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15737 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15738
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015739 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15740 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15741 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15742
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015743no-ssl-reuse
15744 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15745 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15746 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15747 and for paranoid users.
15748
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015749no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015750 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15751 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015752 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015753
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015754 Supported in default-server: No
15755
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015756no-tls-tickets
15757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15758 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15759 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015760 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15761 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015762 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15763 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15764 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015765 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015766
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015767no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015768 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015769 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15770 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015771 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15772 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015773 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015774
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015775 Supported in default-server: No
15776
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015777no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015778 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015779 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15780 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015781 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15782 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015783 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015784
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015785 Supported in default-server: No
15786
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015787no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015788 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015789 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15790 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015791 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15792 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015793 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015794
15795 Supported in default-server: No
15796
15797no-tlsv13
15798 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15799 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15800 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15801 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15802 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015803 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015804
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015805 Supported in default-server: No
15806
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015807no-verifyhost
15808 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15809 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15810 default value.
15811 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15812 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015813
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015814no-tfo
15815 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15816 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15817 default value.
15818 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15819 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15820
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015821non-stick
15822 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15823 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15824 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15825
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015826npn <protocols>
15827 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15828 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15829 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015830 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015831 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15832 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15833 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015835observe <mode>
15836 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15837 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15838 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15839 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15840 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15841 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015842 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015843
15844 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015846on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015847 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15848 Currently, four modes are available:
15849 - fastinter: force fastinter
15850 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15851 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15852 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15853 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15854
15855 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15856
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015857on-marked-down <action>
15858 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15859 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015860 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15861 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15862 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15863 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15864 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15865 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15866 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15867 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015868
15869 Actions are disabled by default
15870
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015871on-marked-up <action>
15872 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15873 Currently one action is available:
15874 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15875 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15876 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15877 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015878 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15879 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015880 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15881 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15882
15883 Actions are disabled by default
15884
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015885pool-low-conn <max>
15886 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15887 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15888 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15889 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15890 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15891 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15892 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15893 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15894 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15895 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015896 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15897 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15898 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15899 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015900
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015901pool-max-conn <max>
15902 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15903 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15904 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15905 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15906 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15907 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15908
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015909pool-purge-delay <delay>
15910 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015911 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015912 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015914port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015915 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015916 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15917 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15918 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15919 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15920 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015921
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015922proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015923 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15924 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15925 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015926 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15927 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15928
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015929 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15930 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15931 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015932
15933 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15934 a server line :
15935
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015936 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015937 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15938 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15939 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15940
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015941 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015942 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15943
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015944 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015946redir <prefix>
15947 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15948 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15949 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15950 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15951 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15952 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15953 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15954 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015955 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015956 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015957 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15958 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15959 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15960 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15961
15962 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015964rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015965 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15966 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15967 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15968
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015969resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15970 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15971 server.
15972
15973 Available options:
15974
15975 * allow-dup-ip
15976 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15977 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15978 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15979 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15980 For such case, simply enable this option.
15981 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15982
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015983 * ignore-weight
15984 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15985 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15986 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15987
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015988 * prevent-dup-ip
15989 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15990 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15991 same fqdn.
15992 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15993
15994 Example:
15995 backend b_myapp
15996 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15997 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15998 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15999
16000 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16001 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16002 it
16003 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16004 different address
16005
16006 Default value: not set
16007
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016008resolve-prefer <family>
16009 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16010 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16011 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16012 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16013
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016014 Default value: ipv6
16015
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016016 Example:
16017
16018 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016019
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016020resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016021 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016022 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016023 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016024 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16025 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016026 configured network, another address is selected.
16027
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016028 Example:
16029
16030 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016031
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016032resolvers <id>
16033 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16034 hostname.
16035
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016036 Example:
16037
16038 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016039
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016040 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016041
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016042send-proxy
16043 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16044 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16045 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16046 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016047 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16048 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16049 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16050 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016051 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016052 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16053 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16054 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16055 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16056 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016057 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16058 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016059
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016060send-proxy-v2
16061 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16062 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16063 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16064 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016065 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16066 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16067 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16068 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016069
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016070proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016071 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16072 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16073
16074 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16075 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16076 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16077 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16078 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16079 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16080 connection is supported).
16081 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16082 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16083 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16084 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16085 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16086 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16087 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016088
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016089send-proxy-v2-ssl
16090 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16091 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16092 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16093 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16094 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16095 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16096 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016097 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16098 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016099
16100send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16101 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16102 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16103 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16104 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16105 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16106 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16107 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16108 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016109 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16110 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016111
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016112shard <shard>
16113 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16114 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16115 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16116 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16117 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16118 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16119 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16120
16121 Example :
16122
16123 peers mypeers
16124 shards 3
16125 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16126 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16127 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16128 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16129
16130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016131slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016132 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16133 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16134 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16135 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16136 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16137 parameters :
16138
16139 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16140 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16141
16142 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16143 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16144 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16145 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16146
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016147 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016148 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16149 seen as failed.
16150
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016151sni <expression>
16152 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16153 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16154 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016155 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16156 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16157 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16158 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016159 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016160 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016161 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16162 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016163
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016164source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016165source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016166source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016167 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16168 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16169 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16170 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16171
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016172 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16173 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16174 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16175 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16176 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16177 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16178 server.
16179
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016180 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16181 specifying the source address without port(s).
16182
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016183ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016184 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16185 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16186 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16187 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16188 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16189 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016190 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16191 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016192
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016193ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16194 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16195 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16196 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16197
16198ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16199 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16200 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16201 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16202
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016203ssl-reuse
16204 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16205 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16206 default value.
16207 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16208 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16209
16210stick
16211 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16212 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16213 default value.
16214 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16215 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016216
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016217socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016218 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016219 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16220 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16221
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016222tcp-ut <delay>
16223 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016224 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016225 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016226 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016227 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16228 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16229 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16230 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16231 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16232 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16233 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16234 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16235 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16236
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016237tfo
16238 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16239 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16240 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16241 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016242 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016243 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016245track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016246 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16247 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16248 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
16249 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016250 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16251
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016252tls-tickets
16253 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16254 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16255 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016256 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16257 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16258 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016259 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016260 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016261
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016262verify [none|required]
16263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016264 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016265 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16266 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016267 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016268 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16269 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16270 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16271 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16272 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16273 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16274 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16275 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016276
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016277verifyhost <hostname>
16278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016279 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16280 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16281 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16282 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16283 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16284 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16285 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16286 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016288weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016289 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16290 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16291 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016292 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16293 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16294 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16295 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16296 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16297 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016298
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016299ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16300 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16301 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16302 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16303
16304 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16305 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16306 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16307 server ALPN contains it.
16308
16309 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16310 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16311 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16312 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16313
16314 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16315 favor of the ALPN extension.
16316
16317 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016319
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163205.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16321-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016322
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016323HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16324using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016325configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016326This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16327can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16328workload.
16329This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16330resolution at run time.
16331Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16332carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16333
16334
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163355.3.1. Global overview
16336----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016337
16338As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16339different steps of the process life:
16340
16341 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16342 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16343 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16344
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016345 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16346 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016347
16348A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16349 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16350 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16351 resolution to know this new IP.
16352
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016353When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016354HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016355SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16356from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016357will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016358will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016359
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016360A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016361 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016362 first valid response.
16363
16364 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16365 servers return an error.
16366
16367
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163685.3.2. The resolvers section
16369----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016370
16371This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016372HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16373contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016374
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016375At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16376no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16377default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16378failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16379
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016380When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16381uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16382is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16383answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16384
16385When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016386used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016387
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016388 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16389 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16390 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016391
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016392 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16393 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016394
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016395 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016396 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16397 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016398
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016399For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16400following scenarios are possible:
16401
16402 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16403 ignored
16404
16405 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16406 applied
16407
16408 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16409 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16410
16411 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16412 retries the query with a new type
16413
16414 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16415 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016416
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016417As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016418a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016419<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016420
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016421
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016422resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016423 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016424
16425A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16426
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016427accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016428 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016429 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016430 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16431 by RFC 6891)
16432
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016433 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16434 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16435 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16436 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16437 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16438 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016439
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016440nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16441 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16442 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16443 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16444 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16445 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16446 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16447 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16448 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16449 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016450 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16451
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016452parse-resolv-conf
16453 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16454 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16455 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16456
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016457hold <status> <period>
16458 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
16459 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016460 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016461 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016462 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
16463 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16464 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
16465
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020016466 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016467
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016468resolve_retries <nb>
16469 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
16470 giving up.
16471 Default value: 3
16472
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016473 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
16474 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
16475 type.
16476
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016477timeout <event> <time>
16478 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
16479 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
16480 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016481 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
16482 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016483 Default value: 1s
16484 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016485 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016486 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016487 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16488 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
16489
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016490 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016491
16492 resolvers mydns
16493 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
16494 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016495 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016496 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016497 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016498 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016499 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016500 hold other 30s
16501 hold refused 30s
16502 hold nx 30s
16503 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016504 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016505 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016506
16507
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200165086. Cache
16509---------
16510
16511HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16512(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16513RAM.
16514
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020016515The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
16516blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016517
16518If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16519independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16520when we try to allocate a new one.
16521
16522The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16523
16524It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16525"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16526for more details.
16527
16528When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16529replaced by "<CACHE>".
16530
16531
165326.1. Limitation
16533----------------
16534
16535The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16536
16537- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010016538- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
16539 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
16540 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016541- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
16542- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010016543- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
16544 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
16545 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016546- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
16547 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010016548- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
16549 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
16550 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016551
16552- If the request is not a GET
16553- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16554- If the request contains an Authorization header
16555
16556
165576.2. Setup
16558-----------
16559
16560To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16561the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16562
16563
165646.2.1. Cache section
16565---------------------
16566
16567cache <name>
16568 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
16569 size of cache is mandatory.
16570
16571total-max-size <megabytes>
16572 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
16573 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
16574
16575max-object-size <bytes>
16576 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
16577 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
16578 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
16579
16580max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016581 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016582 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
16583 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
16584 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
16585 default.
16586
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016587process-vary <on/off>
16588 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016589 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
16590 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
16591 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016592 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016593
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016594max-secondary-entries <number>
16595 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
16596 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
16597 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
16598
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016599
166006.2.2. Proxy section
16601---------------------
16602
16603http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16604 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
16605 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
16606 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
16607 after this one.
16608
16609http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16610 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
16611 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
16612 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
16613 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
16614
16615
16616Example:
16617
16618 backend bck1
16619 mode http
16620
16621 http-request cache-use foobar
16622 http-response cache-store foobar
16623 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16624
16625 cache foobar
16626 total-max-size 4
16627 max-age 240
16628
16629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166307. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16631----------------------------------
16632
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016633HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16635The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16636these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16637but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16638data called patterns.
16639
16640
166417.1. ACL basics
16642---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016643
16644The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16645content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16646from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16647simple :
16648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016650 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016651 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16652 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016654The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16655adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016656
16657In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016659 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016660
16661This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16662Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16663and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016664an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16665conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16666as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16667are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016668
16669ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16670'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16671which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16672
16673There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16674performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016676The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16677specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16678this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016679methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16680ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016681
16682Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16683 - boolean
16684 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16685 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16686 - string
16687 - data block
16688
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016689Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16690converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16691would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16692The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16693which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16694
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016695Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16696keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16697fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16698which are summarized in the table below :
16699
16700 +---------------------+-----------------+
16701 | Sample or converter | Default |
16702 | output type | matching method |
16703 +---------------------+-----------------+
16704 | boolean | bool |
16705 +---------------------+-----------------+
16706 | integer | int |
16707 +---------------------+-----------------+
16708 | ip | ip |
16709 +---------------------+-----------------+
16710 | string | str |
16711 +---------------------+-----------------+
16712 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16713 +---------------------+-----------------+
16714
16715Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16716matching method, see below.
16717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016718The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16719 - boolean
16720 - integer or integer range
16721 - IP address / network
16722 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16723 - regular expression
16724 - hex block
16725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016726The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16727
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016728 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16729 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016731 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016732 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016733 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016734 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016736The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16737read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16738if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16739lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16740will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16741beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016742a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016743lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16744exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16745
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016746The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16747parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16748ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16749a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16750check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16751
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016752The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16753socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16754file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016756Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16757loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16758
16759 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16760
16761In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16762the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16763case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16764as well.
16765
16766The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16767sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16768do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16769methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16770is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016771obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016772followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16773default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16774that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16775string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16776
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016777The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16778By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16779string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16780resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016781server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016782waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016783flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16784function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16787sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16788be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016789
16790 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16791 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016792 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16793 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16794 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16795 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016796
16797 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16798 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016799 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016800
16801 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016802 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016803
16804 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016805 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016806
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016807 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016808 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16809
16810 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16811 binary or string samples.
16812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16814 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16817 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16818 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16821 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016823 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16824 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16827 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016829 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16830 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016831 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016833 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16834 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16835 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016836
16837For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16838request, it is possible to do :
16839
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016840 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016841
16842In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16843buffer, one would use the following acl :
16844
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016845 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016846
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016847On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16848possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16849
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016850 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016852All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16853criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16854method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010016855to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
16856usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
16857converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
16858method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
16859matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016860criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16861the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016863If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016864the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16865For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16868 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16869 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16870 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016871
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016872
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016873The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16874types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16875combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16876brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16877default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879 +-------------------------------------------------+
16880 | Input sample type |
16881 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016882 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016883 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16884 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16885 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016886 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016887 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016888 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016890 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016891 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016892 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016893 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016894 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016896 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016897 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016898 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016900 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016901 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016902 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016903 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016904 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016906 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016907 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16908 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16909 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016910
16911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169127.1.1. Matching booleans
16913------------------------
16914
16915In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16916Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16917When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16918that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16919
16920Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16921return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16922"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16923
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169257.1.2. Matching integers
16926------------------------
16927
16928Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16929enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16930to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16931
16932Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16933matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16934lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016935
16936For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16937unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16938representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16939
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016940As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16941two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16942instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16943ranges and operators.
16944
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016945For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016946operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16947Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16948of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016950Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016951
16952 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16953 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16954 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16955 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16956 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016958For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016959
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016960 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016961
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016962This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16963
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016964 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169677.1.3. Matching strings
16968-----------------------
16969
16970String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16971different forms :
16972
16973 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016974 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016975
16976 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016977 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016978
16979 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16980 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16981
16982 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16983 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16984
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010016985 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
16986 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
16987 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
16988 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
16989 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
16990 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016991
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010016992 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
16993 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
16994 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
16995 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
16996 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
16997 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
16998 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
16999 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17000 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17001 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17002 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017003
17004String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17005exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17006characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17007string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17008to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017009before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017010
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017011Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17012(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17013Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17014
17015Example:
17016 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17017 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17018
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170207.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17021---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017022
17023Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17024they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17025possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17026passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17027the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017028the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17029match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017030
17031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170327.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17033-------------------------------------
17034
17035It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17036not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17037a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17038to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17039digits may be used upper or lower case.
17040
17041Example :
17042 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017043 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017044
17045
170467.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17047---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017048
17049IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17050netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17051within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017052host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017053difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17054at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17055does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17056parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017057
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017058The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17059abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17060
17061 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17062 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17063 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17064 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17065 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17066 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17067 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17068 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17069
17070Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17071192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17072
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017073IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17074Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17075trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17076IPv6 patterns.
17077
17078HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17079following situations :
17080 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17081 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17082 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17083 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17084 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17085 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17086 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17087 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17088 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17089 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017091
170927.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17093----------------------------------
17094
17095Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17096combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17097
17098 - AND (implicit)
17099 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17100 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017102A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017104 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017106Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17107indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017109For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17110"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17111requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17112is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17113
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017114 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017115 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17116 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17117 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017118
17119To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17120and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17121
17122 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17123 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17124 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17125 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17126
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017127 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017128 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17129 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17130 use_backend www if host_www
17131
17132It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17133expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17134be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17135the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17136
17137 The following rule :
17138
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017139 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017140 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017141
17142 Can also be written that way :
17143
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017144 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017145
17146It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17147to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17148simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17149sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17150good use is the following :
17151
17152 With named ACLs :
17153
17154 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17155 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17156 monitor fail if site_dead
17157
17158 With anonymous ACLs :
17159
17160 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17161
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017162See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17163keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017164
17165
171667.3. Fetching samples
17167---------------------
17168
17169Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17170against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17171sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17172ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17173of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17174available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17175
17176This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17177Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17178compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17179deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17180
17181The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17182matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17183method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17184indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17185
17186As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17187when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17188mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17189the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17190ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17191
17192Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17193multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17194when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017195incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17196are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017197is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17198all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17199
17200Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17201 - name
17202 - name(arg1)
17203 - name(arg1,arg2)
17204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017205
172067.3.1. Converters
17207-----------------
17208
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017209Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17210of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17211is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17212was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017213has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017214unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17215
17216These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17217sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17218the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017219support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017220
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017221A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17222support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17223supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17224(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17225bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017227The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017228
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001722951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17230 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17231 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17232 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17233 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17234 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17235
17236 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017237 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17238 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017239 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17240 frontend http-in
17241 bind *:8081
17242 default_backend servers
17243 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17244 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17245
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017246rfc7239_is_valid
17247 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17248 otherwise.
17249
17250 Example:
17251 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17252 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17253 # output: TRUE
17254 #input: "proto=custom"
17255 # output: FALSE
17256
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017257rfc7239_field(<field>)
17258 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17259
17260 Supported fields are:
17261 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17262 - host: http compliant host
17263 - for: RFC7239 node
17264 - by: RFC7239 node
17265
17266 More info here:
17267 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17268
17269 Example:
17270 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17271 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17272 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17273 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17274
17275 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17276 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17277 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17278 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17279
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017280rfc7239_n2nn
17281 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17282 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17283 - ipv4 address
17284 - ipv6 address
17285 - 'unknown'
17286 - '_obfs' identifier
17287
17288 Example:
17289 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17290 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17291 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
17292 #input: "for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17293 # output: 127.0.0.1
17294 #input: "for=\"_name:_port\""
17295 # output: "_name"
17296
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017297rfc7239_n2np
17298 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17299 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17300 - unsigned integer
17301 - '_obfs' identifier
17302
17303 Example:
17304 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17305 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17306 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
17307 #input: "by=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17308 # output: 9999
17309 #input: "by=\"_name:_port\""
17310 # output: "_port"
17311
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017312add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017313 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017314 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017315 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17316 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017317 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017318 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17319 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17320 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17321 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017322 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017323 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017324
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017325add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17326 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17327 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17328 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17329 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17330 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17331 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17332 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17333 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17334 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17335 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17336 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17337 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17338 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17339 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17340 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17341 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17342 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017343 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17344 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017345
17346 Example:
17347 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17348 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17349 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17350 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17351
17352 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17353 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17354
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017355aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17356 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17357 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17358 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17359 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17360 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17361 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17362
17363 Example:
17364 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17365 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17366
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017367and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017368 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017369 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017370 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17371 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017372 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017373 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17374 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17375 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17376 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017377 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017378 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017379
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017380b64dec
17381 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17382 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017383 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17384 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017385
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017386base64
17387 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017388 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017389 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17390 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017391
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017392be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17393 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17394 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17395 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17396 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17397 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17398
17399 Example:
17400 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17401 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17402 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17403 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17404
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017405be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17406 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17407 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17408 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17409 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17410 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17411 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17412
17413 Example:
17414 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17415 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17416 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
17417 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
17418
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017419bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017420 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017421 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017422 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017423 presence of a flag).
17424
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017425bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
17426 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
17427 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017428 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017429
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017430concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
17431 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
17432 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
17433 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
17434 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17435 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
17436 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
17437 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
17438 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
17439 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
17440 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017441 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040017442 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017443 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017444 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
17445 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
17446 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017447
17448 Example:
17449 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
17450 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
17451 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017452 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017453 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017454 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
17455
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017456cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017457 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
17458 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017459
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017460crc32([<avalanche>])
17461 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
17462 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17463 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17464 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17465 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17466 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
17467 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
17468 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
17469 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
17470 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017471 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
17472
17473crc32c([<avalanche>])
17474 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
17475 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17476 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17477 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
17478 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
17479 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
17480 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
17481 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017482
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020017483cut_crlf
17484 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
17485 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
17486 updated.
17487
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010017488da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017489 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
17490 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
17491 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
17492 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017493 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017494 configuration language.
17495
17496 Example:
17497 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017498 bind *:8881
17499 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000017500 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017501
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010017502debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
17503 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
17504 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
17505 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
17506 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
17507 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
17508 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
17509 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
17510 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
17511 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
17512 printable sample types.
17513
17514 Example:
17515 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020017516
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017517digest(<algorithm>)
17518 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
17519 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
17520
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017521 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017522 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17523
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017524div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017525 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17526 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017527 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017528 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
17529 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017530 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017531 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17532 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17533 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17534 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017535 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017536 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017537
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017538djb2([<avalanche>])
17539 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
17540 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17541 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17542 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17543 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17544 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17545 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017546 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
17547 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017548
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017549even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017550 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017551 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
17552
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017553field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17554 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
17555 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
17556 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
17557 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
17558 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
17559 fields.
17560
17561 Example :
17562 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
17563 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17564 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
17565 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
17566 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010017567
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017568fix_is_valid
17569 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
17570 Information eXchange):
17571
17572 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
17573 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017574 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017575 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010017576 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017577 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
17578 checksum
17579
17580 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17581 the server can be parsed.
17582
17583 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
17584 message, false if not.
17585
17586 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
17587
17588 Example:
17589 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17590 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17591
17592fix_tag_value(<tag>)
17593 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
17594 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
17595 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
17596 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050017597 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017598 added.
17599
17600 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17601 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
17602 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
17603 fix_is_valid converter.
17604
17605 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
17606
17607 Example:
17608 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17609 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17610 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
17611 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
17612 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
17613
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017614hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017615 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017616 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017617 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017618 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010017619
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017620hex2i
17621 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017622 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017623
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020017624htonl
17625 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
17626 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
17627 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
17628 unsigned 32-bit integer.
17629
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017630hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017631 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
17632 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
17633 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
17634 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
17635
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017636 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017637 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17638
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017639host_only
17640 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
17641 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17642 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17643 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17644
17645 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
17646
17647 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
17648
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017649http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017650 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17651 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017652 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
17653 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
17654 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
17655 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
17656 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
17657 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
17658 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
17659 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017660
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017661iif(<true>,<false>)
17662 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
17663 string otherwise.
17664
17665 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020017666 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017667
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017668in_table(<table>)
17669 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17670 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
17671 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017672 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017673 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
17674
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017675ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017676 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017677 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017678 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
17679 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
17680 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
17681 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
17682 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017683
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017684json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017685 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017686 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017687 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017688 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
17689 of errors:
17690 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
17691 bytes, ...)
17692 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
17693 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
17694
17695 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
17696 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
17697 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
17698 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
17699 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
17700 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017701 - "ascii" : never fails;
17702 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
17703 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017704 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017705 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017706 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
17707 characters corresponding to the other errors.
17708
17709 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017710 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017711
17712 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017713 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017714 capture request header user-agent len 150
17715 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017716
17717 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17718 GET / HTTP/1.0
17719 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17720
17721 Output log:
17722 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17723
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017724json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17725 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17726 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17727 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17728 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17729
17730 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17731 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17732
17733 Example:
17734 # get a integer value from the request body
17735 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17736 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17737
17738 # get a key with '.' in the name
17739 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17740 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17741
17742 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17743 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17744
17745 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17746 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17747
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017748jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17749 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17750 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17751 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17752 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17753 json_path and output_type parameters.
17754
17755 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17756 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17757
17758jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17759 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17760 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17761 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17762 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17763 json_path and output_type parameters.
17764
17765 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17766 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17767
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017768jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17769 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17770 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017771 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017772 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17773 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17774 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17775 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017776
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017777 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
17778 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
17779 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
17780 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017781
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017782 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17783 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17784 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17785 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17786 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17787 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017788 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017789 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17790
17791 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17792 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17793 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17794 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17795 contents.
17796
17797 The possible return values are the following :
17798
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017799 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17800 | ID | message |
17801 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017802 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017803 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017804 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
17805 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
17806 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17807 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17808 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017809 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017810
17811 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17812 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17813
17814 Example:
17815 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17816 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17817 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17818 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17819 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17820 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17821
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017822language(<value>[,<default>])
17823 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17824 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17825 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17826 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17827 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17828 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17829 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17830 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17831 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017832 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017833 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17834 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017835
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017836 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017837
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017838 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17839 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017840
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017841 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17842 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17843 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17844 use_backend spanish if es
17845 use_backend french if fr
17846 use_backend english if en
17847 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017848
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017849length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017850 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17851 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17852 type. The result is of type integer.
17853
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017854lower
17855 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17856 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17857 type. The result is of type string.
17858
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017859ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17860 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17861 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17862 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17863 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17864 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17865 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17866
17867 Example :
17868
17869 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017870 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017871 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17872
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017873ltrim(<chars>)
17874 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17875 representation of the input sample.
17876
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017877map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17878map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17879map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17880 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17881 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17882 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17883 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17884 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17885 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17886 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17887 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017888
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017889 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17890 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17891 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017892
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017893 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017894 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017895
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017896 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17897 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17898 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17899 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017900 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17901 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017902 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17903 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17904 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17905 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17906 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17907 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17908 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17909 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017910 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17911 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17912 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017913 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17914 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17915 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17916 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17917 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017918
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017919 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17920 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17921 the corresponding match text.
17922
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017923 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17924 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17925 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17926 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17927 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017928
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017929 Example :
17930
17931 # this is a comment and is ignored
17932 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17933 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17934 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17935 | | | `---------- value
17936 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17937 | `---------------------------- key
17938 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17939
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017940mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017941 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17942 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017943 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017944 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017945 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017946 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17947 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17948 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17949 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017950 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017951 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017952
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017953mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017954 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17955 <packettype>.
17956 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17957 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17958 from.
17959 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17960 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17961 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17962
17963 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17964 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17965 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17966 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17967
17968 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17969 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17970 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17971 packets only):
17972 17: Session Expiry Interval
17973 33: Receive Maximum
17974 39: Maximum Packet Size
17975 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17976 25: Request Response Information
17977 23: Request Problem Information
17978 21: Authentication Method
17979 22: Authentication Data
17980 18: Will Delay Interval
17981 1: Payload Format Indicator
17982 2: Message Expiry Interval
17983 3: Content Type
17984 8: Response Topic
17985 9: Correlation Data
17986 Not supported yet:
17987 38: User Property
17988
17989 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17990 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17991 packets only):
17992 17: Session Expiry Interval
17993 33: Receive Maximum
17994 36: Maximum QoS
17995 37: Retain Available
17996 39: Maximum Packet Size
17997 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17998 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17999 31: Reason String
18000 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18001 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18002 42: Shared Subscription Available
18003 19: Server Keep Alive
18004 26: Response Information
18005 28: Server Reference
18006 21: Authentication Method
18007 22: Authentication Data
18008 Not supported yet:
18009 38: User Property
18010
18011 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18012 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18013 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18014 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18015
18016 Example:
18017
18018 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18019 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18020 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18021 if data_in_buffer
18022 # do the same as above
18023 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18024 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18025 if data_in_buffer
18026
18027mqtt_is_valid
18028 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18029
18030 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18031 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18032 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18033 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18034
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018035 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18036
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018037 Example:
18038
18039 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018040 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018041
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018042mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018043 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018044 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18045 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018046 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018047 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018048 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018049 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18050 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18051 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18052 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018053 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018054 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018055
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018056nbsrv
18057 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18058 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18059 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18060 map lookup.
18061
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018062neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018063 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18064 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18065 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18066 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018067
18068not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018069 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018070 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018071 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018072 absence of a flag).
18073
18074odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018075 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018076 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18077
18078or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018079 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018080 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018081 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18082 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018083 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018084 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18085 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18086 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18087 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018088 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018089 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018090
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018091param(<name>,[<delim>])
18092 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18093 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18094 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18095 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18096 a value of an empty string.
18097
18098 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18099 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18100 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18101 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18102
18103 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18104 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18105 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18106 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18107 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18108 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18109
18110 Example :
18111 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18112 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18113 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18114 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18115 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18116
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018117port_only
18118 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18119 returning its port.
18120 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18121 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18122 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18123
18124 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18125
18126 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18127
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018128protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18129 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18130 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18131 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18132 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18133 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18134 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18135 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18136 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18137 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18138 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18139 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18140
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018141regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018142 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18143 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18144 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18145 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18146 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18147 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18148 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18149 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18150 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018151 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18152 of characters with other ones.
18153
18154 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18155 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18156 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18157 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18158 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18159 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018160
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018161 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018162
18163 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18164 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18165 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018166 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018167
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018168 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18169 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18170
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018171 # capture groups and backreferences
18172 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018173 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018174 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18175
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018176capture-req(<id>)
18177 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18178 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18179
18180 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018181 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18182 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018183
18184capture-res(<id>)
18185 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18186 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18187
18188 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018189 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18190 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018191
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018192rtrim(<chars>)
18193 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18194 of the input sample.
18195
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018196sdbm([<avalanche>])
18197 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18198 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18199 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18200 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18201 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18202 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18203 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018204 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18205 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018206
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018207secure_memcmp(<var>)
18208 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18209 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18210 match.
18211
18212 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18213 performed in constant time.
18214
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018215 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018216 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18217
18218 Example :
18219
18220 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18221 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18222 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18223 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18224
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018225set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018226 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018227 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18228 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18229 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18230 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018231 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018232 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18233 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018234 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018235 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18236 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018237 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018238 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018239
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018240 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18241 possible conditions :
18242 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18243 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18244 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18245 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18246 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18247 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18248 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18249 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18250 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18251 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18252 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18253 called on the variable.
18254 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18255 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18256 configuration parsing.
18257 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18258 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18259 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18260 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18261 true by default.
18262
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018263sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018264 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018265 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18266
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018267sha2([<bits>])
18268 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18269 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18270
18271 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18272 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18273
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018274 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018275 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18276
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018277srv_queue
18278 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18279 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18280 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18281 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18282 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18283
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018284strcmp(<var>)
18285 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18286 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18287 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18288 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18289 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18290 shorter).
18291
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018292 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18293 strings in constant time.
18294
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018295 Example :
18296
18297 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18298 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18299 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18300
18301
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018302sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018303 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18304 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018305 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018306 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18307 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018308 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18310 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018311 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018312 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18313 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018314 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018315 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018316
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018317table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18318 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18319 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18320 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18321 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18322 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18323 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18324
18325
18326table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18327 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18328 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18329 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18330 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18331 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18332 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18333
18334table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18335 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18336 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018337 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018338 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18339 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18340
18341table_conn_cur(<table>)
18342 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18343 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18344 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18345 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18346 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18347
18348table_conn_rate(<table>)
18349 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18350 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18351 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18352 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18353 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18354
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018355table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18356 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18357 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18358 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18359 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18360 input sample in the designated table.
18361 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18362
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018363table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18364 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18365 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18366 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18367 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18368 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18369 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18370 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18371 data-type).
18372 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18373
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018374table_gpt0(<table>)
18375 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18376 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18377 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18378 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18379 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18380
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018381table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18382 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18383 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18384 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18385 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18386 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18387 between 0 and 99.
18388 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18389 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18390 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18391 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18392
18393table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18394 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18395 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18396 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18397 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18398 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18399 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18400 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18401 value 0.
18402 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18403 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18404 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18405
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018406table_gpc0(<table>)
18407 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18408 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18409 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18410 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18411 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18412
18413table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18414 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18415 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18416 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
18417 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18418 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
18419 sample fetch keyword.
18420
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018421table_gpc1(<table>)
18422 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18423 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18424 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
18425 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18426 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
18427
18428table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
18429 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18430 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18431 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
18432 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18433 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
18434 sample fetch keyword.
18435
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018436table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
18437 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18438 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018439 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018440 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18441 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18442
18443table_http_err_rate(<table>)
18444 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18445 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18446 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
18447 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
18448 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
18449 keyword.
18450
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018451table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
18452 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18453 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18454 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
18455 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18456 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18457
18458table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
18459 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18460 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18461 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
18462 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
18463 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
18464 keyword.
18465
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018466table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
18467 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18468 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018469 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018470 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18471 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18472
18473table_http_req_rate(<table>)
18474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18476 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
18477 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
18478 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
18479 keyword.
18480
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010018481table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018482 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18483 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18484 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18485 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
18486 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
18487 updated.
18488 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
18489
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018490table_kbytes_in(<table>)
18491 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18492 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018493 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018494 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18495 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18496 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
18497 keyword.
18498
18499table_kbytes_out(<table>)
18500 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18501 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018502 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018503 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18504 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18505 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
18506 keyword.
18507
18508table_server_id(<table>)
18509 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18510 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18511 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
18512 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
18513 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
18514 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
18515
18516table_sess_cnt(<table>)
18517 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18518 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018519 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018520 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
18521 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18522 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
18523 keyword.
18524
18525table_sess_rate(<table>)
18526 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18527 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18528 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
18529 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
18530 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18531 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
18532 keyword.
18533
18534table_trackers(<table>)
18535 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18536 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18537 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18538 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
18539 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
18540 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
18541 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
18542 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
18543 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
18544 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
18545
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018546ub64dec
18547 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
18548 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
18549 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
18550
18551 Example:
18552 # Decoding a JWT payload:
18553 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
18554
18555ub64enc
18556 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
18557
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018558upper
18559 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
18560 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18561 type. The result is of type string.
18562
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020018563url_dec([<in_form>])
18564 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
18565 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
18566 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
18567 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
18568 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
18569 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020018570
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010018571url_enc([<enc_type>])
18572 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
18573 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
18574 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
18575 optional argument is here for future changes.
18576
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018577ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018578 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018579 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
18580 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
18581 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018582 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18583 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18584 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18585 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018586 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018587 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18588 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018589
18590 Example:
18591 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
18592 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
18593
18594 message Point {
18595 int32 latitude = 1;
18596 int32 longitude = 2;
18597 }
18598
18599 message PPoint {
18600 Point point = 59;
18601 }
18602
18603 message Rectangle {
18604 // One corner of the rectangle.
18605 PPoint lo = 48;
18606 // The other corner of the rectangle.
18607 PPoint hi = 49;
18608 }
18609
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018610 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
18611 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
18612 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018613
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018614 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18615 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018616 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018617 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
18618
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018619 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018620
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018621 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018622
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018623 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
18624 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18625 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018626
18627 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
18628 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
18629 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
18630
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018631 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
18632 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
18633 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018634
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018635
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010018636unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010018637 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
18638 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
18639 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
18640 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18641 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
18642 response),
18643 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18644 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
18645 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
18646 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
18647
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018648utime(<format>[,<offset>])
18649 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18650 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
18651 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18652 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18653 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18654 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
18655
18656 Example :
18657
18658 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018659 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018660 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18661
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018662word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18663 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
18664 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
18665 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018666 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018667 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
18668 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
18669
18670 Example :
18671 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
18672 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18673 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
18674 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
18675 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018676 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010018677
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018678wt6([<avalanche>])
18679 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
18680 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18681 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18682 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18683 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18684 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18685 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018686 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
18687 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018688
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018689xor(<value>)
18690 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018691 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018692 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018693 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018694 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018695 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18696 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018697 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018698 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18699 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018700 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018701 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018702
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010018703xxh3([<seed>])
18704 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
18705 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
18706 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
18707 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
18708 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
18709 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
18710 considered as cryptographically secure.
18711
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010018712xxh32([<seed>])
18713 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
18714 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18715 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18716 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18717 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18718 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18719 as cryptographically secure.
18720
18721xxh64([<seed>])
18722 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
18723 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18724 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18725 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18726 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18727 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18728 as cryptographically secure.
18729
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010018730x509_v_err_str
18731 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
18732 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
18733 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
18734
18735 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
18736 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
18737 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
18738
18739 Example:
18740
18741 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18742
18743 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18744 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
18745 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
18746
18747 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
18748 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
18749 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018750
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187517.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018752--------------------------------------------
18753
18754A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
18755not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
18756"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
18757The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
18758
18759always_false : boolean
18760 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18761 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18762
18763always_true : boolean
18764 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18765 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18766
18767avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018768 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018769 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
18770 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
18771 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
18772 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
18773 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
18774 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
18775 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
18776 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
18777 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
18778 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
18779 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
18780 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
18781 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010018782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018783be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018784 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
18785 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
18786 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
18787 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018788 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18789
18790be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18791 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18792 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18793 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18794 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18795 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018796 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18797 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018798
18799 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18800 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18801 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018803be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18804 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18805 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18806 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018807 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18809 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018810
18811 Example :
18812 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18813 backend dynamic
18814 mode http
18815 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18816 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018817
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018818bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018819 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18820 of the string.
18821
18822bool(<bool>) : bool
18823 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18824 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018826connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18827 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018828 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018829 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
18830 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050018831
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018832 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018833 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018834 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
18835
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018836 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
18837 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018838
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018839 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018840 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018841 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018842 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018843 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018844 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018845 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018846
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018847 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
18848 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018849 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018850 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018851
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018852cpu_calls : integer
18853 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
18854 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
18855 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
18856 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
18857 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
18858 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
18859
18860cpu_ns_avg : integer
18861 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18862 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18863 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18864 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18865 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18866 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18867 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
18868 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
18869 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
18870 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
18871 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
18872
18873cpu_ns_tot : integer
18874 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18875 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18876 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18877 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18878 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18879 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18880 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
18881 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
18882 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
18883 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
18884 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
18885 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
18886 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
18887
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018888date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018889 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018890
18891 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
18892 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
18893 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018894 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
18895
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018896 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
18897 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
18898 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
18899 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
18900 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
18901
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018902 Example :
18903
18904 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18905 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018906
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018907 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18908 # millisecond granularity
18909 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18910
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018911date_us : integer
18912 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18913 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18914 from the same timeval structure.
18915
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018916env(<name>) : string
18917 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18918 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18919 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18920 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18921 certain way.
18922
18923 Examples :
18924 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18925 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18926
18927 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018928 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018930fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18931 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018932 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18933 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018934 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18935 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018936 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018937 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18938 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018939
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018940fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18941 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18942 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18943 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018945fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18946 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18947 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18948 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18949 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18950 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18951 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18952 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18953 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018954
18955 Example :
18956 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18957 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18958 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18959 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18960 frontend mail
18961 bind :25
18962 mode tcp
18963 maxconn 100
18964 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18965 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18966 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18967 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018968
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018969hostname : string
18970 Returns the system hostname.
18971
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018972int(<integer>) : signed integer
18973 Returns a signed integer.
18974
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018975ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18976 Returns an ipv4.
18977
18978ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18979 Returns an ipv6.
18980
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018981last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018982 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18983 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18984 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18985 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18986 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18987 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18988 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18989 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18990 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18991 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18992 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18993 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18994
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018995last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018996 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18997 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18998 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18999 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19000 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19001 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19002 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19003 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19004 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19005 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19006 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19007 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19008
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019009lat_ns_avg : integer
19010 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19011 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19012 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19013 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19014 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19015 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19016 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19017 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19018 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019019 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19020 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19021 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19022 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19023 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19024 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019025
19026lat_ns_tot : integer
19027 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19028 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19029 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19030 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19031 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19032 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19033 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19034 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19035 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019036 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19037 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19038 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19039 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19040 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019041 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19042 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19043 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19044 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19045 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19046 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19047
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019048meth(<method>) : method
19049 Returns a method.
19050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019051nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19052 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19053 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19054 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019055 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19056 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19057 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019058
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019059prio_class : integer
19060 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19061 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19062 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19063
19064prio_offset : integer
19065 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19066 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19067 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19068 set-priority-offset".
19069
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019070proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019071 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19072 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019074queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019075 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19076 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19077 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019078 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19079 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19080 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19081 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19082 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19083
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019084quic_enabled : boolean
19085 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
19086 change without deprecation in the future.
19087
19088 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19089 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19090 global option.
19091
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019092rand([<range>]) : integer
19093 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19094 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19095 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19096 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19097 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019099srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19100 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19101 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19102 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19103 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19104 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019105 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19106 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19107
19108srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19109 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19110 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19111 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19112 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19113 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19114 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19115 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19116
19117 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19118 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019119
19120srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19121 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19122 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19123 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019124 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019125 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19126 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19127 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19128
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019129srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19130 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19131 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19132 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19133 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19134 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19135 fetch methods.
19136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019137srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19138 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19139 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019140 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19142 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019143 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019144 overloading servers).
19145
19146 Example :
19147 # Redirect to a separate back
19148 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19149 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19150 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19151
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019152srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019153 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19154 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19155 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19156
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019157srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019158 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19159 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19160 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19161
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019162srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019163 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19164 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19165 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19166
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019167stopping : boolean
19168 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19169 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19170 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19171
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019172str(<string>) : string
19173 Returns a string.
19174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019175table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19176 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19177 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19178
19179table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19180 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19181 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19182 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19183
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019184thread : integer
19185 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19186 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19187 and debugging purposes.
19188
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019189uuid([<version>]) : string
19190 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19191 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19192 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19193
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019194var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019195 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019196 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19197 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19198 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019199 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019200 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19201 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019202 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019203 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19204 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019205 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019206 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019207
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192087.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019209----------------------------------
19210
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019211The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019212closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19213methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19214sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19215TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019216the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19217counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019218"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019219used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19220counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19221"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19222An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19223currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19224the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019225
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019226bc_dst : ip
19227 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19228 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19229 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19230 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19231
19232bc_dst_port : integer
19233 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019234 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019235
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019236bc_err : integer
19237 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19238 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19239 and their corresponding error message.
19240
19241bc_err_str : string
19242 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19243 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19244 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19245 corresponding error message.
19246
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019247bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019248 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19249 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19250 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19251
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019252bc_src : ip
19253 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019254 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019255 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19256 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19257
19258bc_src_port : integer
19259 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019260 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019262be_id : integer
19263 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019264 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19265 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019266
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019267be_name : string
19268 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019269 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19270 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019271
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019272be_server_timeout : integer
19273 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19274 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19275 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19276
19277be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19278 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19279 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19280 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19281
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019282cur_server_timeout : integer
19283 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19284 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19285 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19286
19287cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19288 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19289 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19290 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019292dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019293 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19294 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19295 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19296 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19297 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19298 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19299 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19300 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19301 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19302 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19303 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019304
19305dst_conn : integer
19306 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19307 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19308 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19309 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19310 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19311 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19312 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19313 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019314
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019315dst_is_local : boolean
19316 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19317 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19318 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19319 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019320 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019321 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19322 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19323 it only once per connection.
19324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325dst_port : integer
19326 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19327 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019328 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19329 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19330 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19331 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019332
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019333fc_dst : ip
19334 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19335 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19336 for details.
19337
19338fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19339 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19340 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19341 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19342
19343fc_dst_port : integer
19344 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19345 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19346 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19347
19348fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019349 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19350 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19351 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019352 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019353 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19354
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019355fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019356 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019357 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019358 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019359 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19360
19361 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19362 | ID | message |
19363 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19364 | 0 | "Success" |
19365 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19366 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19367 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19368 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19369 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19370 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19371 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19372 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19373 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19374 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19375 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19376 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19377 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19378 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19379 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19380 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19381 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19382 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19383 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19384 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19385 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19386 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19387 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19388 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19389 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19390 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19391 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19392 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
19393 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
19394 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
19395 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
19396 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
19397 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
19398 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
19399 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
19400 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
19401 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
19402 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
19403 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
19404 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
19405 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
19406 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020019407 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019408 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19409
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019410fc_fackets : integer
19411 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
19412 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19413 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19414 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19415
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020019416fc_http_major : integer
19417 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19418 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19419 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
19420
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019421fc_lost : integer
19422 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
19423 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19424 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19425 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19426
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020019427fc_pp_authority : string
19428 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19429 if any.
19430
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010019431fc_pp_unique_id : string
19432 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19433 if any.
19434
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010019435fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
19436 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
19437 header.
19438
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019439fc_reordering : integer
19440 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
19441 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19442 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19443 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19444
19445fc_retrans : integer
19446 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
19447 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19448 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19449 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19450
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020019451fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19452 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
19453 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19454 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19455 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19456 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19457 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19458
19459fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19460 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19461 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19462 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19463 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19464 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19465 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19466
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020019467fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019468 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19469 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19470 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19471 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19472
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019473fc_src : ip
19474 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19475 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
19476 for details.
19477
19478fc_src_is_local : boolean
19479 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
19480 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
19481 "src_is_local" for details.
19482
19483fc_src_port : integer
19484
19485 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
19486 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
19487 this address. See "src-port" for details.
19488
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019489
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019490fc_unacked : integer
19491 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19492 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19493 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19494 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019495
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020019496fe_defbe : string
19497 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
19498 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
19499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500fe_id : integer
19501 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010019502 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19504
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019505fe_name : string
19506 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
19507 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
19508 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19509
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010019510fe_client_timeout : integer
19511 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
19512 current frontend.
19513
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019514sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019515sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19516sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19517sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019518 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
19519 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19520 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
19521
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019522sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019523sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19524sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19525sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019526 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
19527 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19528 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
19529
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019530sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19531 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19532 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19533 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19534 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19535 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19536 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19537 will always return zero.
19538 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19539 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19540
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019541sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019542sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19543sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19544sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019545 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19546 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019547 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19548 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19549 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019550
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019551 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019552 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19553 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019554 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19555 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
19556 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019557 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19558 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19559
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019560sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19561sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19562sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19563sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19564 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19565 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
19566 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19567 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19568 when a first ACL was verified.
19569
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019570sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019571sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19572sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19573sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019574 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019575 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
19576
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019577sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019578sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19579sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19580sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019581 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19582 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
19583 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
19584
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019585sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019586sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19587sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19588sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019589 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
19590 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
19591 See also src_conn_rate.
19592
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019593sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19594 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
19595 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
19596 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
19597 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19598 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
19599 index, zero is returned.
19600 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19601 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
19602
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019603sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019604sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19605sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19606sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019607 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019608 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019609
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019610sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19611sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19612sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19613sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19614 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19615 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19616
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019617sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19618 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19619 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
19620 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19621 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19622 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
19623 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
19624 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
19625
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019626sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19627sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19628sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19629sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19630 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19631 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
19632
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019633sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19634 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19635 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
19636 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
19637 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
19638 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
19639 between 0 and 2.
19640 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
19641 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19642 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19643 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19644 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19645
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019646sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019647sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19648sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19649sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019650 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
19651 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19652 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019653 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19654 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19655 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019656
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019657sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19658sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19659sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19660sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19661 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19662 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19663 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19664 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19665 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19666 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19667
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019668sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019669sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19670sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19671sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019672 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019673 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
19674 See also src_http_err_cnt.
19675
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019676sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019677sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19678sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19679sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019680 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
19681 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19682 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
19683 src_http_err_rate.
19684
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019685sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19686sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19687sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19688sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19689 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
19690 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
19691 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
19692
19693sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19694sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19695sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19696sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19697 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
19698 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
19699 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
19700 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
19701
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019702sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019703sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19704sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19705sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019706 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019707 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19708 src_http_req_cnt.
19709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019710sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019711sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19712sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19713sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019714 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
19715 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
19716 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19717 src_http_req_rate.
19718
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019719sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19720 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19721 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19722 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19723 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19724 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19725 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19726 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
19727 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19728 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19729
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019730sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019731sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19732sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19733sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019734 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019735 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19736 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19737 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19738 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019739
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019740 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019741 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19742 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019743 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19744
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019745sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19746sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19747sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19748sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19749 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
19750 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19751 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19752 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19753 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
19754
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019755sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019756sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19757sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19758sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019759 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
19760 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19761 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019762
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019763sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019764sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19765sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19766sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019767 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
19768 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19769 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019770
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019771sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019772sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19773sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19774sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019775 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019776 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
19777 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
19778 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019779 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019780 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
19781
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019782sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019783sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19784sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19785sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019786 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
19787 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19788 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
19789 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
19790 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019791 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019792
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019793sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019794sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19795sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19796sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019797 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19798 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19799 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19800
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019801sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019802sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19803sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19804sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019805 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19806 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019807 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019808 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19809 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019810 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19811 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19812 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019814so_id : integer
19815 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19816 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19817 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019818
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019819so_name : string
19820 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19821 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19822 strings instead of integers.
19823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019824src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019825 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19826 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19827 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19828 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
19829 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
19830 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
19831 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
19832 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
19833 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
19834 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
19835 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
19836 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
19837 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
19838 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
19839 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019840
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019841 Example:
19842 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
19843 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
19844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019845src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19846 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
19847 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
19848 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019849 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019851src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19852 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
19853 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019854 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019855 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019856
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019857src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19858 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19859 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19860 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
19861 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19862 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
19863 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19864 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19865 See also sc_clr_gpc.
19866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019867src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19868 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19869 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19870 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19871 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19872 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19873 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019874
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019875 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019876 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19877 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
19878 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
19879 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019880 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019881 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19882 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19883
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019884src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19885 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19886 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19887 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19888 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19889 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19890 was verified.
19891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019892src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019893 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019894 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019895 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019896 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019898src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019899 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019900 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19901 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019902 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019904src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19905 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
19906 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19907 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019908 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019909
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019910src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19911 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19912 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19913 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19914 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19915 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19916 is returned.
19917 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19918 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19919 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019921src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019922 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019923 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019924 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019925 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019926
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019927src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19928 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19929 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19930 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19931 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19932
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019933src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19934 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19935 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19936 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19937 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19938 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19939 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19940
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019941src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19942 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19943 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19944 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19945 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19946
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019947src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19948 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19949 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19950 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19951 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19952 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19953 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19954 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19955 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19956 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19957 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019959src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019960 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019961 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019962 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19963 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019964 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19965 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19966 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019967
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019968src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19969 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19970 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19971 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19972 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19973 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19974 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19975 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019977src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019978 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019979 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019980 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019981 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019982 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019984src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19985 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19986 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19987 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19988 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019989 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019990
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019991src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19992 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19993 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019994 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019995 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19996 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19997
19998src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19999 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20000 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20001 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20002 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20003 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20004 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020006src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020007 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020008 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20009 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020010 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020012src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20013 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20014 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20015 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020016 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020017 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020018
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020019src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20020 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20021 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20022 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20023 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20024 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20025 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20026 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20027 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020029src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20030 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20031 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20032 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020033 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020034 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20035 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020036
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020037 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020038 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020039 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020040 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020041
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020042src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20043 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20044 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20045 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20046 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20047 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20048 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20049
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020050src_is_local : boolean
20051 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20052 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20053 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20054 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020055 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020056 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20057 once per connection.
20058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020059src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020060 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20061 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20062 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20063 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20064 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020066src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020067 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20068 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20069 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20070 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20071 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020073src_port : integer
20074 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020075 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20076 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20077 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20078 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020080src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020081 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020082 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20083 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20084 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020085 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020087src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20088 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20089 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20090 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20091 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020092 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020094src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20095 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20096 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20097 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20098 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20099 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20100 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20101 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20102 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020103
20104 Example :
20105 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20106 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20107 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20108 listen ssh
20109 bind :22
20110 mode tcp
20111 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020112 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020113 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020114 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020116srv_id : integer
20117 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20118 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020119 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020120
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020121srv_name : string
20122 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20123 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020124 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020125
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200201267.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020127----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020129The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020130closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20131when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20132usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020133future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020134
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002013551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20136 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20137 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20138 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20139 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20140 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20141
20142 Example :
20143 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20144 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20145 # the request.
20146 frontend http-in
20147 bind *:8081
20148 default_backend servers
20149 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20150 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20151
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020152ssl_bc : boolean
20153 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20154 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020155 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20156 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020157
20158ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20159 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020160 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20161 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020162
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020163ssl_bc_alpn : string
20164 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20165 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020166 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020167 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20168 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20169 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20170 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20171 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020172 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20173 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020174
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020175ssl_bc_cipher : string
20176 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020177 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20178 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020179
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020180ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20181 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20182 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20183 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020184 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020185
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020186ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020187 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020188 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20189 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20190 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20191 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020192 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20193 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20194 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20195
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020196ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020197 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020198 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20199 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20200 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020201
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020202ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20203 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20204 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020205 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20206 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020207
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020208ssl_bc_npn : string
20209 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20210 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020211 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020212 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20213 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20214 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20215 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020216 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20217 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020218
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020219ssl_bc_protocol : string
20220 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020221 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20222 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020223
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020224ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020225 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020226 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020227 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20228 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020229
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020230ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20231 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20232 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20233 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020234 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020235
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020236ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20237 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20238 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020239 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20240 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020241
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020242ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20243 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20244 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20245 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020246 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020247
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020248ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20249 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020250 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20251 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020253ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20254 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20255 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20256 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20257 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20258 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020260ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20261 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20262 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20263 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20264 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020265
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020266ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020267 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20268 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20269 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020270 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020271 does not support resumed sessions.
20272
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020273ssl_c_der : binary
20274 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20275 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20276 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020278ssl_c_err : integer
20279 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20280 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20281 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20282 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20283 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020284
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020285ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020286 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20287 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20288 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20289 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20290 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20291 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20292 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20293 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020294 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20295 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20296 LDAP v3.
20297 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20298 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020300ssl_c_key_alg : string
20301 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20302 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20303 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020305ssl_c_notafter : string
20306 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20307 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20308 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020310ssl_c_notbefore : string
20311 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20312 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20313 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020314
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020315ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020316 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20317 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20318 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20319 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20320 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20321 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20322 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20323 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020324 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20325 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20326 LDAP v3.
20327 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20328 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020330ssl_c_serial : binary
20331 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20332 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20333 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020335ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20336 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20337 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20338 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020339 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20340 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20341
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020342 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020343 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020345ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20346 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20347 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20348 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020350ssl_c_used : boolean
20351 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20352 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020354ssl_c_verify : integer
20355 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20356 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20357 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20358 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020360ssl_c_version : integer
20361 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20362 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020363
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020364ssl_f_der : binary
20365 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20366 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20367 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20368
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020369ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020370 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20371 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20372 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20373 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020374 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020375 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20376 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20377 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020378 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20379 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20380 LDAP v3.
20381 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20382 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020384ssl_f_key_alg : string
20385 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20386 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
20387 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020389ssl_f_notafter : string
20390 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20391 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20392 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020394ssl_f_notbefore : string
20395 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20396 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20397 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020398
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020399ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020400 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20401 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20402 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20403 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20404 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20405 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20406 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20407 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020408 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20409 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20410 LDAP v3.
20411 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20412 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020414ssl_f_serial : binary
20415 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20416 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20417 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020418
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020020419ssl_f_sha1 : binary
20420 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
20421 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20422 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020424ssl_f_sig_alg : string
20425 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20426 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20427 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020429ssl_f_version : integer
20430 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20431 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20432
20433ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020434 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20435 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
20436 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
20437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020438 Example :
20439 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
20440 listen http-https
20441 bind :80
20442 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
20443 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
20444
20445ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
20446 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
20447 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20448
20449ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020450 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020451 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020452 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020453 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20454 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20455 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
20456 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
20457 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
20458 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
20459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020460ssl_fc_cipher : string
20461 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
20462 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020020463
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020464ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20465 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
20466 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020467 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020468 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20469 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20470 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020471
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020472 Example:
20473 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20474 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20475 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20476 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20477 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20478 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20479 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20480 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20481 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20482
20483ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020484 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020485 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020486 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
20487 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020488 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20489 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020490
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020491ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020492 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020493 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020494 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020495 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20496 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20497 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20498 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
20499 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
20500 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020501
20502ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020503 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020504 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
20505 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020506
20507ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
20508 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
20509 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020510 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020511
20512 Example:
20513 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20514 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20515 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20516 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20517 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20518 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20519 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20520 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20521 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20522
20523ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20524 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
20525 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020526 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020527 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20528 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
20529 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20530
20531 Example:
20532 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20533 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20534 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20535 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20536 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20537 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20538 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20539 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20540 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20541
20542ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20543 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
20544 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020545 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020546 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20547 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
20548 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20549
20550 Example:
20551 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20552 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20553 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20554 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20555 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20556 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20557 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20558 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20559 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020560
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020561ssl_fc_client_random : binary
20562 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20563 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20564 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20565
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020566ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
20567 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20568 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20569 transport layer.
20570 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20571 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20572 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20573 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20574
20575ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20576 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20577 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20578 transport layer.
20579 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20580 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20581 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20582 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20583
20584ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
20585 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20586 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20587 transport layer.
20588 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20589 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20590 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20591 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20592
20593ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
20594 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20595 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20596 transport layer.
20597 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20598 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20599 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20600 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20601
20602ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
20603 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20604 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20605 transport layer.
20606 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20607 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20608 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20609 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20610
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020611ssl_fc_err : integer
20612 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20613 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20614 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
20615 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
20616 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
20617 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
20618 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
20619 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
20620 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
20621 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
20622 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
20623 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20624 codes.
20625
20626ssl_fc_err_str : string
20627 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20628 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20629 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
20630 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
20631 also "ssl_fc_err".
20632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020633ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020634 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
20635 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010020636 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
20637 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
20638 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
20639 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020640
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020020641ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
20642 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
20643 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
20644 wait until the handshake happened.
20645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020646ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
20647 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020648 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
20649 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020650 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020651 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020652
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020020653ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020654 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010020655 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
20656 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020658ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020659 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020660 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020661 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
20662 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
20663 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
20664 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
20665 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
20666 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020020667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020668ssl_fc_protocol : string
20669 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
20670 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020671
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020672ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
20673 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
20674 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020675 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
20676 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020677
20678 Example:
20679 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20680 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20681 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20682 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20683 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20684 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20685 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20686 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20687 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20688
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020689ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020690 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020691 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010020692 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020693
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020694ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20695 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20696 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20697 transport layer.
20698 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20699 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20700 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20701 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20702
20703ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
20704 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20705 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20706 transport layer.
20707 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20708 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20709 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20710 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20711
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020712ssl_fc_server_random : binary
20713 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20714 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20715 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020717ssl_fc_session_id : binary
20718 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
20719 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
20720 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
20721 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020722
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020723ssl_fc_session_key : binary
20724 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
20725 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20726 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
20727 BoringSSL.
20728
20729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020730ssl_fc_sni : string
20731 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
20732 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020733 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020734 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
20735 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
20736
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020737 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020738 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020739 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020740 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020020741 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020742
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010020743 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
20744 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
20745 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
20746 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
20747 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
20748 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
20749 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
20750 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
20751 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
20752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020753 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020754 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
20755 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020020756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020757ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
20758 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
20759 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020760
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020761ssl_s_der : binary
20762 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
20763 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20764 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20765
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020766ssl_s_chain_der : binary
20767 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
20768 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20769 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020770 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020771 does not support resumed sessions.
20772
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020773ssl_s_key_alg : string
20774 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20775 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
20776 SSL/TLS transport layer.
20777
20778ssl_s_notafter : string
20779 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
20780 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20781 transport layer.
20782
20783ssl_s_notbefore : string
20784 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
20785 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20786 transport layer.
20787
20788ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20789 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20790 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20791 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20792 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20793 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20794 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020795 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20796 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020797 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20798 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20799 LDAP v3.
20800 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20801 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20802
20803ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20804 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20805 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20806 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20807 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20808 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20809 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020810 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20811 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020812 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20813 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20814 LDAP v3.
20815 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20816 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20817
20818ssl_s_serial : binary
20819 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20820 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20821 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20822
20823ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20824 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20825 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20826 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20827
20828ssl_s_sig_alg : string
20829 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20830 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20831 layer.
20832
20833ssl_s_version : integer
20834 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
20835 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020836
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200208377.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020838------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020840Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
20841sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
20842only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
20843For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
20844be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
20845can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
20846sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
20847for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
20848content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020849
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020850Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
20851 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020852 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020853 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
20854 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
20855 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
20856 sample expression). So be careful.
20857
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010020858distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
20859 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
20860 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
20861 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
20862 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
20863 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
20864 list of supported tokens.
20865
20866distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
20867 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
20868 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
20869 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
20870 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
20871 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
20872 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
20873 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
20874 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
20875 supported tokens.
20876
20877 Example :
20878 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
20879 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
20880 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
20881 # send large files to the big farm
20882 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
20883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020884payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020885 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020886 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
20887 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020889payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
20890 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020891 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020892 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020894req.len : integer
20895req_len : integer (deprecated)
20896 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20897 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20898 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20899 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20900 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020901 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020902 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
20903 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020905req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20906 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020907 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
20908 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
20909 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
20910 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020911
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020912 ACL derivatives :
20913 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020915req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20916 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20917 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20918 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
20919 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020920
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020921 ACL derivatives :
20922 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020924 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020926req.proto_http : boolean
20927req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20928 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20929 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20930 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20931 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20932 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20933 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20934 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020936 Example:
20937 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20938 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20939 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020940 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020942req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20943rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20944 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20945 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20946 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20947 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20948 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20949 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20950 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020952 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20953 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20954 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20955 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20956 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20957 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020959 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020960 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020962 Example :
20963 listen tse-farm
20964 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20965 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20966 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20967 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20968 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20969 persist rdp-cookie
20970 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20971 # This is only useful makes sense if
20972 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20973 stick-table type string size 204800
20974 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20975 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20976 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020978 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020979 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020981req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20982rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20983 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20984 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20985 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20986 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020988 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020989 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020990
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020991req.ssl_alpn : string
20992 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20993 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20994 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20995 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20996 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20997 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020998 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020999
21000 Examples :
21001 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21002 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021003 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021004 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021005 default_backend bk_default
21006
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021007req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21008 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21009 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021010 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21011 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21012 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21013 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21014 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021016req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21017req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21018 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21019 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21020 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21021 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21022 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21023 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21024 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021026req.ssl_sni : string
21027req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21028 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21029 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21030 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21031 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21032 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021033 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21034 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21035 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21036 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21037 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21038 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21039 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21040 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21041 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021043 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021044 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021046 Examples :
21047 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21048 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021049 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021050 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021051 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021052
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021053req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21054 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21055 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21056 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21057 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21058 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21059 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21060 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21061 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21062 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021064req.ssl_ver : integer
21065req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21066 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21067 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21068 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21069 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21070 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21071 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21072 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021073 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021074 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021076 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021077 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021078
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021079res.len : integer
21080 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21081 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21082 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21083 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21084 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021085 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021086 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021087 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021089res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21090 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021091 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021092 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021093 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021094 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021096res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21097 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21098 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21099 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021100 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21101 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021103 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021104
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021105res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21106rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21107 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21108 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21109 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21110 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21111 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21112 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21113 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021115wait_end : boolean
21116 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21117 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021118 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021119 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21120 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021121 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021122 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21123 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021125 Examples :
21126 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21127 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21128 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021130 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21131 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21132 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21133 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21134 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21135 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21136 tcp-request content reject
21137
21138
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200211397.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021140--------------------------------------
21141
21142It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21143This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21144data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21145its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21146HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21147content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21148to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21149more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21150response are indexed.
21151
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021152Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21153 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21154 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21155 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21156 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21157 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21158 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021160base : string
21161 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21162 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21163 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21164 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21165 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21166 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21167 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21168 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21169
21170 ACL derivatives :
21171 base : exact string match
21172 base_beg : prefix match
21173 base_dir : subdir match
21174 base_dom : domain match
21175 base_end : suffix match
21176 base_len : length match
21177 base_reg : regex match
21178 base_sub : substring match
21179
21180base32 : integer
21181 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21182 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21183 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021184 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21185 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21186 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021187
21188base32+src : binary
21189 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21190 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21191 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21192 per-URL counters.
21193
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021194baseq : string
21195 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21196 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21197 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21198 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21199
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021200capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21201 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21202 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21203 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21204
21205capture.req.method : string
21206 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21207 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21208 because it's allocated.
21209
21210capture.req.uri : string
21211 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21212 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21213 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21214 allocated.
21215
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021216capture.req.ver : string
21217 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21218 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21219 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21220
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021221capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21222 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21223 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21224 The first entry is an index of 0.
21225 See also: "capture response header"
21226
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021227capture.res.ver : string
21228 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21229 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21230 persistent flag.
21231
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021232req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021233 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21234 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21235 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021236
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021237req.body_param([<name>) : string
21238 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21239 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21240 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21241 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
21242 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
21243 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
21244 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
21245 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
21246 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
21247 given.
21248
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021249req.body_len : integer
21250 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21251 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021252 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21253 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021254
21255req.body_size : integer
21256 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021257 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21258 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021260req.cook([<name>]) : string
21261cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21262 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21263 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21264 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21265 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21266 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21267 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21268 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21269 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21270
21271 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021272 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21273 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21274 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21275 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21276 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21277 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21278 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21279 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021281req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21282cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21283 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21284 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021286req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21287cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21288 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21289 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21290 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21291 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021293cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21294 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21295 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21296 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21297 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021298 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021299 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21300 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21301 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21302 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021304hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21305 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21306 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21307 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21308 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021309 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021311req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021312 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21313 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21314 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21315 with headers such as User-Agent.
21316
21317 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21318 found.
21319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021320 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21321 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21322 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021323 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021325req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21326 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21327 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021328 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21329 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021331req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021332 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21333 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21334 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21335 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21336 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21337 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21338 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21339
21340 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21341 found.
21342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021343 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21344 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21345 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021346 with -1 being the last one.
21347
21348 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21349 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021351 ACL derivatives :
21352 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21353 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21354 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21355 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21356 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21357 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21358 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21359 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21360
21361req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21362hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21363 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21364 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021365 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21366 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21367 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21368
21369 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21370 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21371 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21372
21373 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021374
21375req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21376hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21377 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21378 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
21379 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010021380 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
21381 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
21382 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
21383 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
21384 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021385
21386 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21387
21388 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021389
21390req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21391hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
21392 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
21393 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
21394 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021395
21396 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21397
21398 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021399
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021400req.hdrs : string
21401 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
21402 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21403 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
21404 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21405
21406req.hdrs_bin : binary
21407 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21408 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
21409 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
21410 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
21411 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
21412 names and values (length of 0 for both).
21413
21414 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021415
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021416 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21417 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021419http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
21420 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
21421 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
21422 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21423 basic auth is supported.
21424
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020021425http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
21426 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
21427 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
21428 performed on the data sent by the client.
21429 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
21430 Authorization one.
21431
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021432http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
21433 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
21434 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
21435 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
21436 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021437 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21438 basic auth is supported.
21439
21440 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021441 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
21442 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
21443 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
21444 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021445
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021446http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021447 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
21448 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21449 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021450
21451http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021452 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
21453 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21454 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021455
21456http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021457 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
21458 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
21459 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021461http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021462 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
21463 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021464 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
21465 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021467method : integer + string
21468 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
21469 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
21470 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
21471 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
21472 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
21473 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
21474 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021476 ACL derivatives :
21477 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021479 Example :
21480 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
21481 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
21482 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021484path : string
21485 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
21486 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
21487 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
21488 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
21489 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021490 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021491 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021493 ACL derivatives :
21494 path : exact string match
21495 path_beg : prefix match
21496 path_dir : subdir match
21497 path_dom : domain match
21498 path_end : suffix match
21499 path_len : length match
21500 path_reg : regex match
21501 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021502
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020021503pathq : string
21504 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
21505 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
21506 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
21507 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
21508 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
21509 result in both cases.
21510
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021511query : string
21512 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
21513 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
21514 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
21515 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021516 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021517 which stops before the question mark.
21518
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021519req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21520 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21521 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21522 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
21523 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021525req.ver : string
21526req_ver : string (deprecated)
21527 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
21528 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
21529 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021531 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021532 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021533
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021534res.body : binary
21535 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
21536 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021537 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21538
21539 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021540
21541res.body_len : integer
21542 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
21543 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021544 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21545
21546 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021547
21548res.body_size : integer
21549 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
21550 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21551 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
21552 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021553 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21554
21555 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021556
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010021557res.cache_hit : boolean
21558 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
21559 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
21560
21561res.cache_name : string
21562 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
21563 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
21564 empty string.
21565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021566res.comp : boolean
21567 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
21568 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
21569 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021571res.comp_algo : string
21572 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
21573 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
21574 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021576res.cook([<name>]) : string
21577scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21578 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21579 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021580 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21581
21582 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021584 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021585 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021587res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21588scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21589 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21590 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021591 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
21592
21593 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021595res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21596scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21597 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21598 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021599 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21600
21601 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021603res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021604 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21605 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21606
21607 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
21608 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
21609
21610 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
21611
21612 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021614res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021615 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21616 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21617
21618 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
21619 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
21620
21621 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021623res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21624shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021625 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21626 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21627
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021628 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021629 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
21630
21631 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021633 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021634 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21635 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21636 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21637 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21638 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21639 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21640 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21641 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021642
21643res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21644shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021645 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21646 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21647
21648 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021649 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021650
21651 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021653res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21654shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021655 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
21656 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21657
21658 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21659
21660 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021661
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021662res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21663 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21664 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21665 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021666 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21667
21668 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021670res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21671shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021672 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
21673 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21674
21675 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21676
21677 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021678
21679res.hdrs : string
21680 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
21681 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21682 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021683 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21684
21685 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021686
21687res.hdrs_bin : binary
21688 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21689 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
21690 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
21691 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
21692 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
21693 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
21694 (length of 0 for both).
21695
21696 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
21697
21698 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21699 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021701res.ver : string
21702resp_ver : string (deprecated)
21703 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021704 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
21705
21706 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021708 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021709 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021711set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21712 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21713 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021714 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021715 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021717 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
21718 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021720status : integer
21721 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
21722 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021723 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
21724
21725 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021726
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020021727unique-id : string
21728 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
21729 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
21730 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
21731 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
21732 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
21733 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
21734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021735url : string
21736 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
21737 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
21738 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
21739 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
21740 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
21741 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
21742 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021744 ACL derivatives :
21745 url : exact string match
21746 url_beg : prefix match
21747 url_dir : subdir match
21748 url_dom : domain match
21749 url_end : suffix match
21750 url_len : length match
21751 url_reg : regex match
21752 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021754url_ip : ip
21755 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
21756 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
21757 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
21758 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021759 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
21760 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021762url_port : integer
21763 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021764 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021765
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021766urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
21767url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021768 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
21769 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021770 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
21771 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
21772 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
21773 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021774 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
21775 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021776 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
21777 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021779 ACL derivatives :
21780 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
21781 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
21782 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
21783 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
21784 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
21785 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
21786 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
21787 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021788
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021790 Example :
21791 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
21792 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
21793 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
21794 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021795
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021796urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021797 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
21798 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
21799 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020021800
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020021801url32 : integer
21802 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
21803 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
21804 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
21805 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
21806 is an unsigned integer.
21807
21808url32+src : binary
21809 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21810 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21811 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21812
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021813
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200218147.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021815---------------------------------------
21816
21817This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21818used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21819purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21820There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21821or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21822any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21823for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21824
21825internal.htx.data : integer
21826 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21827 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21828
21829internal.htx.free : integer
21830 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
21831 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21832
21833internal.htx.free_data : integer
21834 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
21835 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21836
21837internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010021838 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
21839 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
21840 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021841
21842internal.htx.nbblks : integer
21843 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
21844 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21845
21846internal.htx.size : integer
21847 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
21848 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21849
21850internal.htx.used : integer
21851 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
21852 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21853 direction.
21854
21855internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
21856 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21857 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
21858 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
21859 of the special value :
21860 * head : The oldest inserted block
21861 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021862 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021863
21864internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
21865 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21866 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
21867 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
21868 integer or one of the special value :
21869 * head : The oldest inserted block
21870 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021871 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021872
21873internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
21874 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21875 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
21876 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21877 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21878
21879 * head : The oldest inserted block
21880 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021881 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021882
21883internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
21884 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21885 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21886 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21887 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21888
21889 * head : The oldest inserted block
21890 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021891 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021892
21893internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
21894 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21895 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21896 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21897 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21898
21899 * head : The oldest inserted block
21900 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021901 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021902
21903internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
21904 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
21905 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
21906 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21907 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21908
21909 * head : The oldest inserted block
21910 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021911 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021912
21913internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
21914 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
21915 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
21916 it returns false.
21917
21918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200219197.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021920---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021922Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21923every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021924order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021926ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021927---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21928FALSE always_false never match
21929HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21930HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21931HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021932HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021933HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21934HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21935HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21936HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021937LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021938METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21939METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21940METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21941METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21942METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21943METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21944METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21945METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21946RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21947REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21948TRUE always_true always match
21949WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21950---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021951
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219538. Logging
21954----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021955
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021956One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21957provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21958very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21959provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21960state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021961to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021962headers.
21963
21964In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21965about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21966send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21967
21968 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21969 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21970 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21971 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21972 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021973 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021974 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021975
21976The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21977allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21978as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21979while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21980real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21981delay.
21982
21983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219848.1. Log levels
21985---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021986
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021987TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021988source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021989HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21990in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21991track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21992syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21993about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021994
21995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219968.2. Log formats
21997----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021998
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021999HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022000and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22001slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22002options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022003
22004 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22005 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22006 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22007 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22008 extents.
22009
22010 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22011 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22012 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22013 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22014 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22015
22016 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22017 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22018 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22019 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22020 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22021
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022022 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22023 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22024 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22025 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22026
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022027 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22028
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022029Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22030specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22031field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22032servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22033always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22034identifier.
22035
22036Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22037 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22038 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22039 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22040 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22041
22042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220438.2.1. Default log format
22044-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022045
22046This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22047as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22048format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22049
22050 Example :
22051 listen www
22052 mode http
22053 log global
22054 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22055
22056 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22057 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22058 (www/HTTP)
22059
22060 Field Format Extract from the example above
22061 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22062 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22063 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22064 4 'to' to
22065 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22066 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22067
22068Detailed fields description :
22069 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22070 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22071 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22072 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22073 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22074 and processed the connection.
22075 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22076
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022077In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22078"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22079connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22080
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022081It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22082will eventually disappear.
22083
22084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220858.2.2. TCP log format
22086---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022087
22088The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22089is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22090information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22091counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22092emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22093environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22094the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22095sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022096specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022097not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22098
22099The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22100exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022101if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22102Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022103
22104 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22105 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22106 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022107 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22108 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022109
22110A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22111are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022112
22113 Example :
22114 frontend fnt
22115 mode tcp
22116 option tcplog
22117 log global
22118 default_backend bck
22119
22120 backend bck
22121 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22122
22123 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22124 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22125 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22126
22127 Field Format Extract from the example above
22128 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22129 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22130 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22131 4 frontend_name fnt
22132 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22133 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22134 7 bytes_read* 212
22135 8 termination_state --
22136 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22137 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22138
22139Detailed fields description :
22140 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022141 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022142 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22143 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022144 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022145 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022146 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022147
22148 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022149 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22150 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22151 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022152
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022153 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022154 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22155 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022156 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22157 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22158 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22159 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022160
22161 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22162 and processed the connection.
22163
22164 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22165 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22166 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22167 applications.
22168
22169 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22170 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22171 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22172 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22173 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22174
22175 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22176 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22177 See "Timers" below for more details.
22178
22179 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22180 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22181 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22182 "Timers" below for more details.
22183
22184 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022185 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022186 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22187 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22188 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22189 details.
22190
22191 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22192 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22193 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22194 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22195 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22196
22197 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22198 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22199 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22200 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22201 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22202 for more details.
22203
22204 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022205 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022206 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22207 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22208 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022209 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022210
22211 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22212 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22213 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22214 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22215 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22216 caused by a denial of service attack.
22217
22218 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22219 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22220 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22221 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22222 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22223 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22224 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22225 denial of service attack.
22226
22227 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22228 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22229 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22230 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22231 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22232 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22233 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22234 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22235 be processed than on other servers.
22236
22237 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22238 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22239 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22240 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022241 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022242 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22243 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22244 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22245 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22246 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22247 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22248 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22249 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22250
22251 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22252 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22253 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22254 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22255 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22256 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022257 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022258 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22259
22260 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22261 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22262 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22263 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22264 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22265 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022266 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022267 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22268 occurs.
22269
22270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222718.2.3. HTTP log format
22272----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022273
22274The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22275is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22276the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22277are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22278emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22279generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22280"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22281which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022282frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22283is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022284
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022285The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22286exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022287if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22288instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022289
22290 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22291 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22292 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22293
22294And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22295this exact string:
22296
22297 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22298 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22299 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22300 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022301 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22302 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022303
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022304Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22305slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22306with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22307
22308 Example :
22309 frontend http-in
22310 mode http
22311 option httplog
22312 log global
22313 default_backend bck
22314
22315 backend static
22316 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22317
22318 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22319 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22320 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022321 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022322
22323 Field Format Extract from the example above
22324 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22325 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022326 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022327 4 frontend_name http-in
22328 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022329 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022330 7 status_code 200
22331 8 bytes_read* 2750
22332 9 captured_request_cookie -
22333 10 captured_response_cookie -
22334 11 termination_state ----
22335 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22336 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22337 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22338 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22339 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022340
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022341Detailed fields description :
22342 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022343 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022344 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22345 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022346 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022347 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022348 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022349
22350 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022351 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22352 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22353 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022354
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022355 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022356 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022357
22358 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22359 and processed the connection.
22360
22361 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22362 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22363 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
22364
22365 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22366 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22367 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22368 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
22369 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
22370 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
22371
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022372 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
22373 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
22374 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022375 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022376 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
22377 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022378 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022379 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022380
22381 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22382 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022383 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022384
22385 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22386 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022387 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
22388 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022389
22390 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
22391 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
22392 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
22393 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
22394 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022395 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
22396 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022397
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022398 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022399 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
22400 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
22401 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
22402 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
22403 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
22404 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022405 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022406
22407 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022408 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
22409 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022410
22411 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
22412 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022413 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022414 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
22415 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
22416 overflowing.
22417
22418 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
22419 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
22420 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
22421 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
22422 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
22423 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
22424 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
22425 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22426
22427 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
22428 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
22429 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
22430 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
22431 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
22432 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
22433 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
22434 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22435
22436 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22437 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22438 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
22439 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
22440 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
22441 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
22442 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
22443
22444 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022445 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022446 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
22447 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
22448 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022449 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022450 system.
22451
22452 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22453 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22454 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22455 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22456 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22457 caused by a denial of service attack.
22458
22459 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22460 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22461 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22462 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22463 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22464 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22465 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22466 denial of service attack.
22467
22468 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22469 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22470 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22471 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22472 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22473 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22474 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22475 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
22476 processed than on other servers.
22477
22478 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22479 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22480 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22481 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022482 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022483 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22484 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22485 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22486 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22487 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22488 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22489 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22490 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22491
22492 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22493 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22494 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22495 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22496 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22497 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022498 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022499 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22500
22501 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22502 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22503 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22504 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22505 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22506 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022507 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022508 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22509 occurs.
22510
22511 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
22512 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
22513 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
22514 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
22515 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
22516 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
22517 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
22518 cookies" below for more details.
22519
22520 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
22521 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
22522 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
22523 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
22524 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
22525 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
22526 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
22527 and cookies" below for more details.
22528
22529 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
22530 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
22531 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
22532 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
22533 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
22534 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
22535 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
22536 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
22537
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022538
225398.2.4. HTTPS log format
22540----------------------
22541
22542The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
22543extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
22544information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
22545frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
22546end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
22547matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
22548sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
22549dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
22550"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22551
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022552The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22553exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022554if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22555instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022556
22557 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
22558 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22559 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
22560 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022561 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022562 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
22563 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022564
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022565This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
22566appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
22567HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022568
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022569 Example :
22570 frontend https-in
22571 mode http
22572 option httpslog
22573 log global
22574 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
22575 default_backend bck
22576
22577 backend static
22578 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
22579
22580 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22581 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
22582 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022583 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
22584 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022585
22586 Field Format Extract from the example above
22587 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22588 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
22589 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
22590 4 frontend_name https-in
22591 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
22592 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
22593 7 status_code 200
22594 8 bytes_read* 2750
22595 9 captured_request_cookie -
22596 10 captured_response_cookie -
22597 11 termination_state ----
22598 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22599 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22600 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22601 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22602 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022603 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022604 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022605 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
22606 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022607
22608Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022609 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
22610 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
22611 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022612
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022613 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
22614 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
22615 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050022616 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022617 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022618
22619 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
22620 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
22621 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
22622 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
22623
22624 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
22625 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
22626 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
22627 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
22628
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022629 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
22630 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
22631 can be shared by multiple requests.
22632
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022633 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
22634 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
22635 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
22636 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
22637 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
22638
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022639 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
22640
22641 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
22642
22643
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100226448.2.5. Error log format
22645-----------------------
22646
22647When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
22648protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
22649unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
22650line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
22651"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
22652will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
22653logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
22654
22655The default format looks like this :
22656
22657 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
22658 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
22659 Connection error during SSL handshake
22660
22661 Field Format Extract from the example above
22662 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
22663 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
22664 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
22665 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
22666 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
22667
22668These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
22669failures.
22670
22671By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
22672above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
22673defined format.
22674
22675An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
22676source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
22677number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
22678internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
22679error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
22680the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
22681certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
22682indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
22683indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
22684ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
22685are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
22686would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
22687regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
22688
22689 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010022690 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010022691 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
22692 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
22693
22694
226958.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022696------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022697
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022698When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
22699ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
22700a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
22701formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
22702looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
22703and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022704
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022705HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022706Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
22707separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
22708prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
22709
22710Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
22711variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022712("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022713
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022714If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020022715as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022716less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
22717the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
22718
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020022719Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
22720"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
22721delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
22722preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022723
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022724Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
22725'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
22726https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
22727such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
22728
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022729Flags are :
22730 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022731 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022732 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
22733 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022734
22735 Example:
22736
22737 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
22738 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
22739
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022740 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
22741
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022742Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
22743
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022744 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022745 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022746 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
22747 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
22748 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022749 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
22750 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
22751 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022752 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022753 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000022754 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000022755 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000022756 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022757 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
22758 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010022759 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020022760 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022761 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010022762 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022763 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020022764 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080022765 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022766 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
22767 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
22768 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
22769 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
22770 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022771 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022772 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022773 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022774 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022775 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022776 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
22777 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022778 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22779 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
22780 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022781 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022782 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
22783 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022784 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022785 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22786 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
22787 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020022788 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020022789 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022790 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
22791 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
22792 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
22793 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020022794 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022795 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022796 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022797 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010022798 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022799 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022800 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
22801 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
22802 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022803 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022804 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
22805 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022806 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022807 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
22808 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020022809 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022810 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022811 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022812 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022813
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022814 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022815
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228178.3. Advanced logging options
22818-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022819
22820Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22821just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22822options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22823for more information about their usage.
22824
22825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228268.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22827------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022828
22829It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022830HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022831commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
22832monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
22833ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
22834
22835 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
22836 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
22837 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
22838 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
22839
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020022840 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
22841 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022842
22843 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
22844 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
22845 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
22846
22847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228488.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
22849----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022850
22851The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
22852what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
22853or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022854"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022855just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
22856log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
22857after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
22858is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
22859with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
22860with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
22861
22862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228638.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
22864------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022865
22866Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
22867for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
22868"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
22869retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
22870raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
22871a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
22872file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
22873you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
22874"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
22875
22876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228778.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
22878--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022879
22880Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
22881multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
22882them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
22883"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
22884logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
22885error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
22886and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
22887too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
22888useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
22889alternative.
22890
22891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228928.4. Timing events
22893------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022894
22895Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
22896reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
22897the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
22898frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022899mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
22900addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
22901
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022902Timings events in HTTP mode:
22903
22904 first request 2nd request
22905 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
22906 t tr t tr ...
22907 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
22908 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
22909 :<---- Tq ---->: :
22910 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022911 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022912 :<--------- Ta --------->:
22913
22914Timings events in TCP mode:
22915
22916 TCP session
22917 |<----------------->|
22918 t t
22919 ---|----|----|----|----|---
22920 | Th Tw Tc Td |
22921 |<------ Tt ------->|
22922
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022923 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022924 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022925 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
22926 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
22927 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022928 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022929 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22930 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22931 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22932 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022933
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022934 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22935 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22936 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022937 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22938 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22939 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22940 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22941 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22942 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022943
22944 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22945 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22946 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22947 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22948 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22949 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22950 request typed by hand during a test.
22951
22952 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22953 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022954 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022955 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22956 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22957 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22958 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022959
22960 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22961 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22962 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22963 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22964 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22965
22966 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22967 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22968 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22969 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22970 connection never established.
22971
22972 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22973 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22974 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22975 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22976 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22977 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22978 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22979 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22980 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22981 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22982 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22983
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022984 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
22985 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
22986 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
22987 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
22988 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
22989 by subtracting other timers when valid :
22990
22991 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
22992
22993 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22994 "Ta" can never be negative.
22995
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022996 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22997 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022998 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22999 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023000 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023001
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023002 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023003
23004 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023005 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23006 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023007
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023008 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23009 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23010 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23011 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23012 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23013 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23014 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23015 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23016
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023017These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23018protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23019that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023020due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23021"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23022that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023023
23024Most common cases :
23025
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023026 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23027 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23028 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23029 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23030 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023031 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023032 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23033 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23034 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23035 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23036 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023037 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023038
23039 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23040 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23041 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23042 of ms on remote networks.
23043
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023044 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23045 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23046 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023047
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023048 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23049 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023050 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023051 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23052 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23053 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23054 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23055 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23056 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023057
23058Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23059
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023060 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023061 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023062 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023063
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023064 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023065 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23066 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23067
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023068 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023069 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23070 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23071 flags.
23072
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023073 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23074 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023075 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23076 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23077 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23078 the client connection was maintained open.
23079
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023080 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023081 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023082 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023083 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23084
23085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230868.5. Session state at disconnection
23087-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023088
23089TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23090"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
230912-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23092each of which has a special meaning :
23093
23094 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23095 session to terminate :
23096
23097 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23098
23099 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23100 server explicitly refused it.
23101
23102 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23103 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23104 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23105 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023106 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023107
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023108 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023109 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023110
23111 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23112 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23113 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23114 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23115 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23116
23117 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23118 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23119 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23120 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23121 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023123 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023124 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23125
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023126 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023127 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23128 backup connections when going up.
23129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023130 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023131
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023132 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23133 send or receive data.
23134
23135 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23136 send or receive data.
23137
23138 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23139 with nothing left in the buffers.
23140
23141 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23142
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023143 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023144 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23145
23146 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23147 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23148 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23149 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23150 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23151
23152 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23153 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23154
23155 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23156 server (HTTP only).
23157
23158 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23159
23160 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23161 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23162 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23163
23164 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23165 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23166 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23167
23168 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23169
23170 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23171 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23172
23173 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23174 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23175 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23176
23177 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23178 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023179 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23180 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023181
23182 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23183 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23184 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23185 another server.
23186
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023187 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023188 server.
23189
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023190 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23191 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23192 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23193 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23194
23195 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23196 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23197 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23198 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23199
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023200 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23201 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23202 "use-server" rule).
23203
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023204 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23205
23206 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23207 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23208
23209 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23210
23211 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23212 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23213 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23214
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023215 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23216 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023217 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023218 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23219 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23220
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023221 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23222
23223 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23224 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23225
23226 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23227
23228 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23229
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023230The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23231was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023232helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23233starvation, attacks, etc...
23234
23235The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23236alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23237easier finding and understanding.
23238
23239 Flags Reason
23240
23241 -- Normal termination.
23242
23243 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023244 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23245 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023246 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23247
23248 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23249 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023250 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23251 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023252 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23253 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023254
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023255 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23256 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023257 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023258
23259 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23260 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23261 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23262
23263 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23264 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23265 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23266 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23267 the server takes too long to respond.
23268
23269 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23270 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23271 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23272 long a time to respond.
23273
23274 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23275 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23276 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023277 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023278 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23279 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023280
23281 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23282 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23283 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23284 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23285 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023286 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023287 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23288 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23289 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23290 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23291 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23292 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23293 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23294 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023295 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023296 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23297 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23298 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023299
23300 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23301 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023302 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23303 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23304 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23305 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023306
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023307 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023308 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
23309
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023310 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023311 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23312 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023313 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023314 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23315 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23316
23317 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23318 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23319 503 or 504 here.
23320
23321 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023322 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023323 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23324 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23325 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23326
23327 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23328 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023329 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023330 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023331 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023332
23333 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23334 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23335 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23336 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23337 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23338 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023339 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023340
23341 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23342 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23343 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23344 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
23345 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
23346 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
23347 solution is to fix the application.
23348
23349 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
23350 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
23351 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
23352 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
23353 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
23354 external attacks.
23355
23356 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070023357 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023358 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023359 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
23360 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
23361
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023362 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
23363 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
23364 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023365 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020023366 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023367
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023368 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
23369 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
23370 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
23371 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023372 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
23373 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
23374 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
23375 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023376 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
23377 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
23378 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
23379 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023380
23381 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
23382 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
23383 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023384 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
23385 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
23386 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
23387 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023388
23389 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
23390 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
23391 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
23392 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
23393
23394 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
23395 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
23396 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
23397 only be solved by proper system tuning.
23398
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023399The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023400persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023401important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
23402re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
23403
23404 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
23405
23406 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23407 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
23408 set on a GET request.
23409
23410 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
23411 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023412 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023413 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
23414
23415 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
23416 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
23417 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
23418
23419 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23420 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
23421 already got a cookie.
23422
23423 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23424 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
23425 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
23426 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
23427 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
23428
23429 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23430 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23431 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23432
23433 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
23434 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23435 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23436
23437 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
23438 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
23439
23440 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
23441 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
23442 then advertised in the response.
23443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234458.6. Non-printable characters
23446-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023447
23448In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
23449consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
23450converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
23451prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
23452being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
23453escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
23454is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
23455'}' when logging headers.
23456
23457Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
23458issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
23459containing spaces is "User-Agent".
23460
23461Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
23462the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
23463performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
23464
23465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234668.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
23467---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023468
23469Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
23470achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023471section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023472cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
23473the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
23474the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023475locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023476not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
23477user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
23478a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
23479wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
23480
23481 Examples :
23482 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
23483 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
23484
23485 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
23486 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
23487
23488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
23490---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023491
23492Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
23493proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
23494the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
23495server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
23496
23497Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
23498response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023499section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023500
23501It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023502time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
23503appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023504are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
23505and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
23506follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
23507request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
23508in the logs.
23509
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023510As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
23511frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
23512an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
23513
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023514 Example :
23515 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
23516 listen proxy-out
23517 mode http
23518 option httplog
23519 option logasap
23520 log global
23521 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
23522
23523 # log the name of the virtual server
23524 capture request header Host len 20
23525
23526 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
23527 capture request header Content-Length len 10
23528
23529 # log the beginning of the referrer
23530 capture request header Referer len 20
23531
23532 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
23533 capture response header Server len 20
23534
23535 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
23536 capture response header Content-Length len 10
23537
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023538 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023539 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
23540
23541 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
23542 capture response header Via len 20
23543
23544 # log the URL location during a redirection
23545 capture response header Location len 20
23546
23547 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
23548 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
23549 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23550 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
23551 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
23552
23553 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23554 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23555 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23556 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023557 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023558
23559 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23560 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23561 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23562 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
23563 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023564 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023565
23566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235678.9. Examples of logs
23568---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023569
23570These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
23571them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
23572reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
23573
23574 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
23575 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23576 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23577
23578 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
23579 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
23580
23581 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
23582 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
23583 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23584
23585 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
23586 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
23587
23588 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
23589 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23590 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
23591
23592 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023593 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023594 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
23595 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
23596
23597 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
23598 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
23599 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
23600
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023601 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
23602 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
23603 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
23604 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023605 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023606 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023607
23608 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023609 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023610
23611 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
23612 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
23613 Nothing was sent to any server.
23614
23615 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
23616 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
23617
23618 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
23619 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023620 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023621 send a 408 return code to the client.
23622
23623 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
23624 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
23625
23626 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
23627 5 seconds ("c----").
23628
23629 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
23630 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023631 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023632
23633 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023634 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023635 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
23636 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
23637 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
23638 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
23639 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010023640
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020023641
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200236429. Supported filters
23643--------------------
23644
23645Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
23646accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
23647unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
23648
23649See also : "filter"
23650
236519.1. Trace
23652----------
23653
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010023654filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023655
23656 Arguments:
23657 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
23658 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
23659
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010023660 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023661
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023662 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023663 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
23664 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
23665 amount of the parsed data.
23666
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023667 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010023668
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023669This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
23670callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
23671information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
23672filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
23673
23674Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
23675tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
23676a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
23677
23678
236799.2. HTTP compression
23680---------------------
23681
23682filter compression
23683
23684The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
23685keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023686when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
23687fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
23688done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
23689explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
23690filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
23691listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23692order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023693
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023694See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
23695 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023696
23697
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200236989.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
23699--------------------------------------------
23700
23701filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
23702
23703 Arguments :
23704
23705 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
23706 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
23707 parsed.
23708
23709 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
23710 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
23711 part must be placed in its own scope.
23712
23713The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
23714external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023715streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023716exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
23717also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
23718
23719SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
23720the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
23721
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010023722For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023723"doc/SPOE.txt".
23724
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100237259.4. Cache
23726----------
23727
23728filter cache <name>
23729
23730 Arguments :
23731
23732 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
23733
23734The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
23735"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023736cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023737other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
23738case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
23739is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
23740filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010023741listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23742order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010023743
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023744See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
23745 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
23746
23747
237489.5. Fcgi-app
23749-------------
23750
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023751filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023752
23753 Arguments :
23754
23755 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
23756
23757The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
23758request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
23759reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
23760used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
23761implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
23762used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
23763fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
23764used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23765order.
23766
23767See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
23768 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
23769
23770
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100237719.6. OpenTracing
23772----------------
23773
23774The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
23775HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
23776of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
23777Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
23778
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023779This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023780
23781The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
23782HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
23783participates in the work of HAProxy.
23784
23785filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
23786
23787 Arguments :
23788
23789 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
23790 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
23791 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
23792 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
23793 OpenTracing filters.
23794
23795 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
23796 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
23797 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
23798 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
23799 filter must have its own scope defined.
23800
23801More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020023802of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023803
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200238049.7. Bandwidth limitation
23805--------------------------
23806
23807filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23808filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23809filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23810filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23811
23812 Arguments :
23813
23814 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
23815 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
23816
23817 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
23818 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23819 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23820 expressed in bytes.
23821
23822 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
23823 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
23824 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
23825 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23826
23827 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
23828 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
23829 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23830
23831 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023832 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023833 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
23834 is expressed in milliseconds.
23835
23836 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
23837 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
23838 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23839 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23840 expressed in bytes.
23841
23842Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
23843speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
23844bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
23845used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
23846sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
23847other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
23848connections for a given client.
23849
23850The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
23851filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
23852definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
23853the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
23854compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
23855the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
23856for the cache filter.
23857
23858There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
23859default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050023860to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023861the table.
23862
23863In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
23864limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
23865forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
23866the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
23867used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
23868cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
23869level.
23870
23871The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
23872connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
23873of the same connection may have different limits.
23874
23875For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
23876defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
23877bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
23878only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
23879when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
23880
23881For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
23882incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
23883corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23884stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23885used to limit outgoing data.
23886
23887Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
23888limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
23889to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
23890carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
23891it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
23892limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
23893experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
23894a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
23895start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
23896some experimentations.
23897
23898 Example:
23899 frontend http
23900 bind *:80
23901 mode http
23902
23903 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
23904 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
23905 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
23906
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023907 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023908 # independently of all other streams.
23909 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
23910
23911 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
23912 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
23913 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
23914 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
23915 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
23916 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
23917 ...
23918
23919 backend limit-by-src
23920 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
23921 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
23922
23923See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
23924 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
23925 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
23926 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023927
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002392810. FastCGI applications
23929-------------------------
23930
23931HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
23932feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
23933the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
23934FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
23935servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
23936FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
23937backend.
23938
23939HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
23940application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
23941connection.
23942
2394310.1. Setup
23944-----------
23945
2394610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
23947--------------------------
23948
23949fcgi-app <name>
23950 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
23951 document root must be defined.
23952
23953acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
23954 Declare or complete an access list.
23955
23956 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
23957 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
23958 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
23959 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
23960 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
23961
23962docroot <path>
23963 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
23964 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
23965 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
23966
23967index <script-name>
23968 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
23969 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
23970 is an optional setting.
23971
23972 Example :
23973 index index.php
23974
23975log-stderr global
23976log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010023977 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023978 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
23979
23980 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
23981 default STDERR messages are ignored.
23982
23983pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23984 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
23985 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
23986 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23987
23988 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
23989 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
23990 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
23991 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
23992
23993 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
23994 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
23995
23996path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023997 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023998 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
23999 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24000 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24001 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24002 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24003 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24004 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024005
24006 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024007 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024008 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24009 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24010 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24011 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024012
24013 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024014 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24015 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024016
24017option get-values
24018no option get-values
24019 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24020
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024021 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024022 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24023
24024 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24025 application will accept.
24026
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024027 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24028 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024029
24030 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024031 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024032 option is disabled.
24033
24034 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24035 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24036 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24037 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24038 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24039 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24040
24041option keep-conn
24042no option keep-conn
24043 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24044 sending a response.
24045
24046 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24047 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24048
24049option max-reqs <reqs>
24050 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24051 accept.
24052
24053 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24054 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24055 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24056 to 1.
24057
24058option mpxs-conns
24059no option mpxs-conns
24060 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24061
24062 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24063 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24064
24065set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24066 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24067 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24068 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24069 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24070
24071 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24072 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24073 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24074
24075 Example :
24076 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24077 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24078
24079 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24080
24081
2408210.1.2. Proxy section
24083---------------------
24084
24085use-fcgi-app <name>
24086 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24087
24088 Arguments :
24089 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24090
24091 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24092 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24093 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24094 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24095 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24096
24097 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24098 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24099 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24100 application are evaluated.
24101
24102
2410310.1.3. Example
24104---------------
24105
24106 frontend front-http
24107 mode http
24108 bind *:80
24109 bind *:
24110
24111 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24112 default_backend back-static
24113
24114 backend back-static
24115 mode http
24116 server www A.B.C.D:80
24117
24118 backend back-dynamic
24119 mode http
24120 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24121 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24122
24123 fcgi-app php-fpm
24124 log-stderr global
24125 option keep-conn
24126
24127 docroot /var/www/my-app
24128 index index.php
24129 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24130
24131
2413210.2. Default parameters
24133------------------------
24134
24135A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24136the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024137script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024138applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24139
24140 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24141 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24142 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24143 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24144 | | |
24145 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24146 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24147 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24148 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24149 | | application. |
24150 | | |
24151 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24152 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24153 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24154 | | |
24155 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24156 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24157 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24158 | | the application's configuration. |
24159 | | |
24160 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24161 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24162 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24163 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24164 | | |
24165 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24166 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24167 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24168 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24169 | | be defined. |
24170 | | |
24171 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24172 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24173 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24174 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24175 | | is not set too. |
24176 | | |
24177 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24178 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24179 | | set. |
24180 | | |
24181 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24182 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24183 | | the request. |
24184 | | |
24185 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24186 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24187 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24188 | | |
24189 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24190 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24191 | | script to process the request. |
24192 | | |
24193 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24194 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24195 | | |
24196 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24197 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24198 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24199 | | |
24200 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24201 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24202 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24203 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24204 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24205 | | |
24206 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24207 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24208 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24209 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24210 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24211 | | side. |
24212 | | |
24213 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24214 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24215 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24216 | | connected to. |
24217 | | |
24218 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24219 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24220 | | |
24221 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024222 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24223 | | current HAProxy version. |
24224 | | |
24225 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024226 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24227 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24228 | | |
24229 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24230
24231
2423210.3. Limitations
24233------------------
24234
24235The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24236way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24237during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24238establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24239application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24240or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24241message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24242these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24243and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24244
24245Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24246request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24247requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24248
24249About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24250into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24251fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24252"http-request" ones.
24253
24254Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24255FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24256processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24257must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24258here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024259
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024260
2426111. Address formats
24262-------------------
24263
24264Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24265address.
24266
24267This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24268The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24269of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24270equivalent is '::'.
24271
24272Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24273is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24274
24275This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24276family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24277
24278Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24279configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24280use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24281'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24282
24283Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24284socket type and the transport method.
24285
24286
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002428711.1. Address family prefixes
24288-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024289
24290'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24291
24292'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24293 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24294 listening.
24295
24296'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24297 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24298 on the statement using this address, a port or
24299 a port range may or must be specified.
24300
24301'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24302 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24303 using this address, a port or a port range
24304 may or must be specified.
24305
24306'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24307 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24308 using this address, a port or a port range
24309 may or must be specified.
24310
24311'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24312 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24313 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24314 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24315 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24316 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24317
24318'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24319 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24320 start by slash '/'.
24321
24322
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002432311.2. Socket type prefixes
24324--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024325
24326Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24327type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24328this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24329This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24330but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24331
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024332Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
24333use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
24334sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
24335known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
24336and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024337
24338If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
24339they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24340report this to the maintainers.
24341
24342'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24343 to "stream"
24344
24345'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24346 to "datagram".
24347
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024348'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
24349 method to "stream".
24350
24351
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024352
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002435311.3. Protocol prefixes
24354-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024355
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024356'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24357 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
24358 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24359 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24360 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024361 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24362 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024363
24364'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24365 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
24366 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24367 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24368 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024369 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24370 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024371
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024372'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24373 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24374 socket type and transport method is forced to
24375 "stream". Depending on the statement using
24376 this address, a port or a port range can or
24377 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24378 of 'stream+ip@'.
24379
24380'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24381 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24382 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24383 statement using this address, a port or port
24384 range can or must be specified.
24385 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24386
24387'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24388 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24389 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24390 statement using this address, a port or port
24391 range can or must be specified.
24392 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24393
24394'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24395 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24396 socket type and transport method is forced to
24397 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
24398 this address, a port or a port range can or
24399 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24400 of 'dgram+ip@'.
24401
24402'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24403 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24404 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24405 the statement using this address, a port or
24406 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024407 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024408
24409'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24410 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24411 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24412 the statement using this address, a port or
24413 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024414 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024415
24416'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24417 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
24418 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
24419
24420'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24421 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
24422 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
24423
24424In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
24425QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
24426
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010024427/*
24428 * Local variables:
24429 * fill-column: 79
24430 * End:
24431 */